2009-12-15 Tristan Gingold <gingold@adacore.com>
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / breakpoint.c
1 /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1986, 1987, 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
4 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007,
5 2008, 2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6
7 This file is part of GDB.
8
9 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
10 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
11 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
12 (at your option) any later version.
13
14 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
15 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
16 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
17 GNU General Public License for more details.
18
19 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
20 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
21
22 #include "defs.h"
23 #include "arch-utils.h"
24 #include <ctype.h>
25 #include "hashtab.h"
26 #include "symtab.h"
27 #include "frame.h"
28 #include "breakpoint.h"
29 #include "tracepoint.h"
30 #include "gdbtypes.h"
31 #include "expression.h"
32 #include "gdbcore.h"
33 #include "gdbcmd.h"
34 #include "value.h"
35 #include "command.h"
36 #include "inferior.h"
37 #include "gdbthread.h"
38 #include "target.h"
39 #include "language.h"
40 #include "gdb_string.h"
41 #include "demangle.h"
42 #include "annotate.h"
43 #include "symfile.h"
44 #include "objfiles.h"
45 #include "source.h"
46 #include "linespec.h"
47 #include "completer.h"
48 #include "gdb.h"
49 #include "ui-out.h"
50 #include "cli/cli-script.h"
51 #include "gdb_assert.h"
52 #include "block.h"
53 #include "solib.h"
54 #include "solist.h"
55 #include "observer.h"
56 #include "exceptions.h"
57 #include "memattr.h"
58 #include "ada-lang.h"
59 #include "top.h"
60 #include "wrapper.h"
61 #include "valprint.h"
62 #include "jit.h"
63 #include "xml-syscall.h"
64
65 /* readline include files */
66 #include "readline/readline.h"
67 #include "readline/history.h"
68
69 /* readline defines this. */
70 #undef savestring
71
72 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
73
74 /* Arguments to pass as context to some catch command handlers. */
75 #define CATCH_PERMANENT ((void *) (uintptr_t) 0)
76 #define CATCH_TEMPORARY ((void *) (uintptr_t) 1)
77
78 /* Prototypes for local functions. */
79
80 static void enable_delete_command (char *, int);
81
82 static void enable_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *);
83
84 static void enable_once_command (char *, int);
85
86 static void enable_once_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *);
87
88 static void disable_command (char *, int);
89
90 static void enable_command (char *, int);
91
92 static void map_breakpoint_numbers (char *, void (*)(struct breakpoint *));
93
94 static void ignore_command (char *, int);
95
96 static int breakpoint_re_set_one (void *);
97
98 static void clear_command (char *, int);
99
100 static void catch_command (char *, int);
101
102 static void watch_command (char *, int);
103
104 static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *);
105
106 static void break_command_1 (char *, int, int);
107
108 static void mention (struct breakpoint *);
109
110 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made static. */
111 struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
112 struct symtab_and_line,
113 enum bptype);
114
115 static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int);
116
117 static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
118 CORE_ADDR bpaddr,
119 enum bptype bptype);
120
121 static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *,
122 struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR,
123 struct obj_section *, int);
124
125 static int breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1,
126 CORE_ADDR addr1,
127 struct address_space *aspace2,
128 CORE_ADDR addr2);
129
130 static void breakpoints_info (char *, int);
131
132 static void breakpoint_1 (int, int);
133
134 static bpstat bpstat_alloc (const struct bp_location *, bpstat);
135
136 static int breakpoint_cond_eval (void *);
137
138 static void cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *);
139
140 static void commands_command (char *, int);
141
142 static void condition_command (char *, int);
143
144 static int get_number_trailer (char **, int);
145
146 void set_breakpoint_count (int);
147
148 typedef enum
149 {
150 mark_inserted,
151 mark_uninserted
152 }
153 insertion_state_t;
154
155 static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
156 static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
157
158 static enum print_stop_action print_it_typical (bpstat);
159
160 static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs);
161
162 static int watchpoint_check (void *);
163
164 static void maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *, int);
165
166 static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
167
168 static int hw_watchpoint_used_count (enum bptype, int *);
169
170 static void hbreak_command (char *, int);
171
172 static void thbreak_command (char *, int);
173
174 static void watch_command_1 (char *, int, int);
175
176 static void rwatch_command (char *, int);
177
178 static void awatch_command (char *, int);
179
180 static void do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp);
181
182 static void stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
183
184 static void stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
185
186 static void stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
187
188 static char *ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg);
189
190 static char *ep_parse_optional_filename (char **arg);
191
192 static void catch_exception_command_1 (enum exception_event_kind ex_event,
193 char *arg, int tempflag, int from_tty);
194
195 static void tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
196
197 static void ep_skip_leading_whitespace (char **s);
198
199 static int single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *,
200 CORE_ADDR pc);
201
202 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
203
204 static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt);
205
206 static void update_global_location_list (int);
207
208 static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (int);
209
210 static int is_hardware_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt);
211
212 static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
213
214 static int syscall_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b);
215
216 static void tracepoints_info (char *, int);
217
218 static void delete_trace_command (char *, int);
219
220 static void enable_trace_command (char *, int);
221
222 static void disable_trace_command (char *, int);
223
224 static void trace_pass_command (char *, int);
225
226 static void skip_prologue_sal (struct symtab_and_line *sal);
227
228
229 /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
230 current breakpoint. */
231
232 static int breakpoint_proceeded;
233
234 static const char *
235 bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp)
236 {
237 /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and represent
238 values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at a breakpoint. */
239 static char *bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
240 return bpdisps[(int) disp];
241 }
242
243 /* Prototypes for exported functions. */
244 /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
245 if such is available. */
246 static int can_use_hw_watchpoints;
247
248 static void
249 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
250 struct cmd_list_element *c,
251 const char *value)
252 {
253 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
254 Debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
255 value);
256 }
257
258 /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
259 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
260 for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
261 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */
262 static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support;
263 static void
264 show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
265 struct cmd_list_element *c,
266 const char *value)
267 {
268 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
269 Debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
270 value);
271 }
272
273 /* If 1, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
274 set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
275 If 0, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
276 use hardware breakpoints. */
277 static int automatic_hardware_breakpoints;
278 static void
279 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
280 struct cmd_list_element *c,
281 const char *value)
282 {
283 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
284 Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
285 value);
286 }
287
288 /* If on, gdb will keep breakpoints inserted even as inferior is
289 stopped, and immediately insert any new breakpoints. If off, gdb
290 will insert breakpoints into inferior only when resuming it, and
291 will remove breakpoints upon stop. If auto, GDB will behave as ON
292 if in non-stop mode, and as OFF if all-stop mode.*/
293
294 static const char always_inserted_auto[] = "auto";
295 static const char always_inserted_on[] = "on";
296 static const char always_inserted_off[] = "off";
297 static const char *always_inserted_enums[] = {
298 always_inserted_auto,
299 always_inserted_off,
300 always_inserted_on,
301 NULL
302 };
303 static const char *always_inserted_mode = always_inserted_auto;
304 static void
305 show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
306 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
307 {
308 if (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_auto)
309 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
310 Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
311 value,
312 breakpoints_always_inserted_mode () ? "on" : "off");
313 else
314 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"), value);
315 }
316
317 int
318 breakpoints_always_inserted_mode (void)
319 {
320 return (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_on
321 || (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_auto && non_stop));
322 }
323
324 void _initialize_breakpoint (void);
325
326 /* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */
327 static int executing_breakpoint_commands;
328
329 /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
330 static int overlay_events_enabled;
331
332 /* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
333 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statment deletes the current
334 breakpoint. */
335
336 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS(B) for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next)
337
338 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \
339 for (B = breakpoint_chain; \
340 B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \
341 B = TMP)
342
343 /* Similar iterator for the low-level breakpoints. SAFE variant is not
344 provided so update_global_location_list must not be called while executing
345 the block of ALL_BP_LOCATIONS. */
346
347 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS(B,BP_TMP) \
348 for (BP_TMP = bp_location; \
349 BP_TMP < bp_location + bp_location_count && (B = *BP_TMP); \
350 BP_TMP++)
351
352 /* Iterator for tracepoints only. */
353
354 #define ALL_TRACEPOINTS(B) \
355 for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next) \
356 if ((B)->type == bp_tracepoint)
357
358 /* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */
359
360 struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain;
361
362 /* Array is sorted by bp_location_compare - primarily by the ADDRESS. */
363
364 static struct bp_location **bp_location;
365
366 /* Number of elements of BP_LOCATION. */
367
368 static unsigned bp_location_count;
369
370 /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and ADDRESS
371 for the current elements of BP_LOCATION which get a valid result from
372 bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of
373 BP_LOCATION to scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
374
375 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max;
376
377 /* Maximum offset plus alignment between
378 bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for
379 the current elements of BP_LOCATION which get a valid result from
380 bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of
381 BP_LOCATION to scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
382
383 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max;
384
385 /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint,
386 unlinked from bp_location array, but for which a hit
387 may still be reported by a target. */
388 VEC(bp_location_p) *moribund_locations = NULL;
389
390 /* Number of last breakpoint made. */
391
392 int breakpoint_count;
393
394 /* Number of last tracepoint made. */
395
396 int tracepoint_count;
397
398 /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */
399 static int
400 breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b)
401 {
402 return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled);
403 }
404
405 /* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */
406
407 void
408 set_breakpoint_count (int num)
409 {
410 breakpoint_count = num;
411 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num);
412 }
413
414 /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
415
416 void
417 clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
418 {
419 struct breakpoint *b;
420
421 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
422 b->hit_count = 0;
423 }
424
425 /* Default address, symtab and line to put a breakpoint at
426 for "break" command with no arg.
427 if default_breakpoint_valid is zero, the other three are
428 not valid, and "break" with no arg is an error.
429
430 This set by print_stack_frame, which calls set_default_breakpoint. */
431
432 int default_breakpoint_valid;
433 CORE_ADDR default_breakpoint_address;
434 struct symtab *default_breakpoint_symtab;
435 int default_breakpoint_line;
436 struct program_space *default_breakpoint_pspace;
437
438 \f
439 /* *PP is a string denoting a breakpoint. Get the number of the breakpoint.
440 Advance *PP after the string and any trailing whitespace.
441
442 Currently the string can either be a number or "$" followed by the name
443 of a convenience variable. Making it an expression wouldn't work well
444 for map_breakpoint_numbers (e.g. "4 + 5 + 6").
445
446 If the string is a NULL pointer, that denotes the last breakpoint.
447
448 TRAILER is a character which can be found after the number; most
449 commonly this is `-'. If you don't want a trailer, use \0. */
450 static int
451 get_number_trailer (char **pp, int trailer)
452 {
453 int retval = 0; /* default */
454 char *p = *pp;
455
456 if (p == NULL)
457 /* Empty line means refer to the last breakpoint. */
458 return breakpoint_count;
459 else if (*p == '$')
460 {
461 /* Make a copy of the name, so we can null-terminate it
462 to pass to lookup_internalvar(). */
463 char *varname;
464 char *start = ++p;
465 LONGEST val;
466
467 while (isalnum (*p) || *p == '_')
468 p++;
469 varname = (char *) alloca (p - start + 1);
470 strncpy (varname, start, p - start);
471 varname[p - start] = '\0';
472 if (get_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar (varname), &val))
473 retval = (int) val;
474 else
475 {
476 printf_filtered (_("Convenience variable must have integer value.\n"));
477 retval = 0;
478 }
479 }
480 else
481 {
482 if (*p == '-')
483 ++p;
484 while (*p >= '0' && *p <= '9')
485 ++p;
486 if (p == *pp)
487 /* There is no number here. (e.g. "cond a == b"). */
488 {
489 /* Skip non-numeric token */
490 while (*p && !isspace((int) *p))
491 ++p;
492 /* Return zero, which caller must interpret as error. */
493 retval = 0;
494 }
495 else
496 retval = atoi (*pp);
497 }
498 if (!(isspace (*p) || *p == '\0' || *p == trailer))
499 {
500 /* Trailing junk: return 0 and let caller print error msg. */
501 while (!(isspace (*p) || *p == '\0' || *p == trailer))
502 ++p;
503 retval = 0;
504 }
505 while (isspace (*p))
506 p++;
507 *pp = p;
508 return retval;
509 }
510
511
512 /* Like get_number_trailer, but don't allow a trailer. */
513 int
514 get_number (char **pp)
515 {
516 return get_number_trailer (pp, '\0');
517 }
518
519 /* Parse a number or a range.
520 * A number will be of the form handled by get_number.
521 * A range will be of the form <number1> - <number2>, and
522 * will represent all the integers between number1 and number2,
523 * inclusive.
524 *
525 * While processing a range, this fuction is called iteratively;
526 * At each call it will return the next value in the range.
527 *
528 * At the beginning of parsing a range, the char pointer PP will
529 * be advanced past <number1> and left pointing at the '-' token.
530 * Subsequent calls will not advance the pointer until the range
531 * is completed. The call that completes the range will advance
532 * pointer PP past <number2>.
533 */
534
535 int
536 get_number_or_range (char **pp)
537 {
538 static int last_retval, end_value;
539 static char *end_ptr;
540 static int in_range = 0;
541
542 if (**pp != '-')
543 {
544 /* Default case: pp is pointing either to a solo number,
545 or to the first number of a range. */
546 last_retval = get_number_trailer (pp, '-');
547 if (**pp == '-')
548 {
549 char **temp;
550
551 /* This is the start of a range (<number1> - <number2>).
552 Skip the '-', parse and remember the second number,
553 and also remember the end of the final token. */
554
555 temp = &end_ptr;
556 end_ptr = *pp + 1;
557 while (isspace ((int) *end_ptr))
558 end_ptr++; /* skip white space */
559 end_value = get_number (temp);
560 if (end_value < last_retval)
561 {
562 error (_("inverted range"));
563 }
564 else if (end_value == last_retval)
565 {
566 /* degenerate range (number1 == number2). Advance the
567 token pointer so that the range will be treated as a
568 single number. */
569 *pp = end_ptr;
570 }
571 else
572 in_range = 1;
573 }
574 }
575 else if (! in_range)
576 error (_("negative value"));
577 else
578 {
579 /* pp points to the '-' that betokens a range. All
580 number-parsing has already been done. Return the next
581 integer value (one greater than the saved previous value).
582 Do not advance the token pointer 'pp' until the end of range
583 is reached. */
584
585 if (++last_retval == end_value)
586 {
587 /* End of range reached; advance token pointer. */
588 *pp = end_ptr;
589 in_range = 0;
590 }
591 }
592 return last_retval;
593 }
594
595 /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
596 if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */
597
598 struct breakpoint *
599 get_breakpoint (int num)
600 {
601 struct breakpoint *b;
602
603 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
604 if (b->number == num)
605 return b;
606
607 return NULL;
608 }
609
610 \f
611 /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */
612
613 static void
614 condition_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
615 {
616 struct breakpoint *b;
617 char *p;
618 int bnum;
619
620 if (arg == 0)
621 error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
622
623 p = arg;
624 bnum = get_number (&p);
625 if (bnum == 0)
626 error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg);
627
628 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
629 if (b->number == bnum)
630 {
631 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
632 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
633 {
634 if (loc->cond)
635 {
636 xfree (loc->cond);
637 loc->cond = 0;
638 }
639 }
640 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
641 xfree (b->cond_string);
642
643 if (*p == 0)
644 {
645 b->cond_string = NULL;
646 if (from_tty)
647 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), bnum);
648 }
649 else
650 {
651 arg = p;
652 /* I don't know if it matters whether this is the string the user
653 typed in or the decompiled expression. */
654 b->cond_string = xstrdup (arg);
655 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
656 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
657 {
658 arg = p;
659 loc->cond =
660 parse_exp_1 (&arg, block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
661 if (*arg)
662 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
663 }
664 }
665 breakpoints_changed ();
666 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
667 return;
668 }
669
670 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
671 }
672
673 /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. */
674
675 void
676 breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b, struct command_line *commands)
677 {
678 free_command_lines (&b->commands);
679 b->commands = commands;
680 breakpoints_changed ();
681 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
682 }
683
684 static void
685 commands_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
686 {
687 struct breakpoint *b;
688 char *p;
689 int bnum;
690 struct command_line *l;
691
692 /* If we allowed this, we would have problems with when to
693 free the storage, if we change the commands currently
694 being read from. */
695
696 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
697 error (_("Can't use the \"commands\" command among a breakpoint's commands."));
698
699 p = arg;
700 bnum = get_number (&p);
701
702 if (p && *p)
703 error (_("Unexpected extra arguments following breakpoint number."));
704
705 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
706 if (b->number == bnum)
707 {
708 char *tmpbuf = xstrprintf ("Type commands for when breakpoint %d is hit, one per line.",
709 bnum);
710 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, tmpbuf);
711 l = read_command_lines (tmpbuf, from_tty, 1);
712 do_cleanups (cleanups);
713 breakpoint_set_commands (b, l);
714 return;
715 }
716 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
717 }
718
719 /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
720 input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
721
722 This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
723 that are part of if and while bodies. */
724 enum command_control_type
725 commands_from_control_command (char *arg, struct command_line *cmd)
726 {
727 struct breakpoint *b;
728 char *p;
729 int bnum;
730
731 /* If we allowed this, we would have problems with when to
732 free the storage, if we change the commands currently
733 being read from. */
734
735 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
736 error (_("Can't use the \"commands\" command among a breakpoint's commands."));
737
738 /* An empty string for the breakpoint number means the last
739 breakpoint, but get_number expects a NULL pointer. */
740 if (arg && !*arg)
741 p = NULL;
742 else
743 p = arg;
744 bnum = get_number (&p);
745
746 if (p && *p)
747 error (_("Unexpected extra arguments following breakpoint number."));
748
749 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
750 if (b->number == bnum)
751 {
752 free_command_lines (&b->commands);
753 if (cmd->body_count != 1)
754 error (_("Invalid \"commands\" block structure."));
755 /* We need to copy the commands because if/while will free the
756 list after it finishes execution. */
757 b->commands = copy_command_lines (cmd->body_list[0]);
758 breakpoints_changed ();
759 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
760 return simple_control;
761 }
762 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
763 }
764
765 /* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */
766
767 static int
768 bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl)
769 {
770 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
771 return 0;
772 if (!bl->inserted)
773 return 0;
774 if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0)
775 /* bp isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */
776 return 0;
777 return 1;
778 }
779
780 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
781 by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
782
783 The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
784 b->address - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
785 up to b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
786 The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
787 memaddr ... memaddr + len
788 Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
789 memaddr + len <= b->address - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
790 and:
791 b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */
792
793 void
794 breakpoint_restore_shadows (gdb_byte *buf, ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len)
795 {
796 /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary search. */
797 unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc;
798
799 /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF content. It is
800 safe to report lower value but a failure to report higher one. */
801
802 bc_l = 0;
803 bc_r = bp_location_count;
804 while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r)
805 {
806 struct bp_location *b;
807
808 bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2;
809 b = bp_location[bc];
810
811 /* Check first B->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added constant.
812 Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure the BC element can
813 in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR to MEMADDR + LEN range).
814
815 Use the BP_LOCATION_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety offset so that
816 we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow range tail still reaching
817 MEMADDR. */
818
819 if (b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max >= b->address
820 && b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr)
821 bc_l = bc;
822 else
823 bc_r = bc;
824 }
825
826 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
827
828 for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_location_count; bc++)
829 {
830 struct bp_location *b = bp_location[bc];
831 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
832 int bp_size = 0;
833 int bptoffset = 0;
834
835 if (b->owner->type == bp_none)
836 warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
837 b->owner->number);
838
839 /* Performance optimization: any futher element can no longer affect BUF
840 content. */
841
842 if (b->address >= bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
843 && memaddr + len <= b->address
844 - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
845 break;
846
847 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (b))
848 continue;
849 if (!breakpoint_address_match (b->target_info.placed_address_space, 0,
850 current_program_space->aspace, 0))
851 continue;
852
853 /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
854 we need to copy. */
855 bp_addr = b->target_info.placed_address;
856 bp_size = b->target_info.shadow_len;
857
858 if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr)
859 /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we
860 are reading. */
861 continue;
862
863 if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len)
864 /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
865 reading. */
866 continue;
867
868 /* Offset within shadow_contents. */
869 if (bp_addr < memaddr)
870 {
871 /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */
872 bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr;
873 bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr;
874 bp_addr = memaddr;
875 }
876
877 if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len)
878 {
879 /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */
880 bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len);
881 }
882
883 memcpy (buf + bp_addr - memaddr,
884 b->target_info.shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size);
885 }
886 }
887 \f
888
889 /* A wrapper function for inserting catchpoints. */
890 static void
891 insert_catchpoint (struct ui_out *uo, void *args)
892 {
893 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) args;
894 int val = -1;
895
896 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_catchpoint);
897 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->insert != NULL);
898
899 b->ops->insert (b);
900 }
901
902 static int
903 is_hardware_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
904 {
905 return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
906 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
907 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint);
908 }
909
910 /* Find the current value of a watchpoint on EXP. Return the value in
911 *VALP and *RESULTP and the chain of intermediate and final values
912 in *VAL_CHAIN. RESULTP and VAL_CHAIN may be NULL if the caller does
913 not need them.
914
915 If a memory error occurs while evaluating the expression, *RESULTP will
916 be set to NULL. *RESULTP may be a lazy value, if the result could
917 not be read from memory. It is used to determine whether a value
918 is user-specified (we should watch the whole value) or intermediate
919 (we should watch only the bit used to locate the final value).
920
921 If the final value, or any intermediate value, could not be read
922 from memory, *VALP will be set to NULL. *VAL_CHAIN will still be
923 set to any referenced values. *VALP will never be a lazy value.
924 This is the value which we store in struct breakpoint.
925
926 If VAL_CHAIN is non-NULL, *VAL_CHAIN will be released from the
927 value chain. The caller must free the values individually. If
928 VAL_CHAIN is NULL, all generated values will be left on the value
929 chain. */
930
931 static void
932 fetch_watchpoint_value (struct expression *exp, struct value **valp,
933 struct value **resultp, struct value **val_chain)
934 {
935 struct value *mark, *new_mark, *result;
936 volatile struct gdb_exception ex;
937
938 *valp = NULL;
939 if (resultp)
940 *resultp = NULL;
941 if (val_chain)
942 *val_chain = NULL;
943
944 /* Evaluate the expression. */
945 mark = value_mark ();
946 result = NULL;
947
948 TRY_CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
949 {
950 result = evaluate_expression (exp);
951 }
952 if (ex.reason < 0)
953 {
954 /* Ignore memory errors, we want watchpoints pointing at
955 inaccessible memory to still be created; otherwise, throw the
956 error to some higher catcher. */
957 switch (ex.error)
958 {
959 case MEMORY_ERROR:
960 break;
961 default:
962 throw_exception (ex);
963 break;
964 }
965 }
966
967 new_mark = value_mark ();
968 if (mark == new_mark)
969 return;
970 if (resultp)
971 *resultp = result;
972
973 /* Make sure it's not lazy, so that after the target stops again we
974 have a non-lazy previous value to compare with. */
975 if (result != NULL
976 && (!value_lazy (result) || gdb_value_fetch_lazy (result)))
977 *valp = result;
978
979 if (val_chain)
980 {
981 /* Return the chain of intermediate values. We use this to
982 decide which addresses to watch. */
983 *val_chain = new_mark;
984 value_release_to_mark (mark);
985 }
986 }
987
988 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint: returns true if the current thread
989 and its running state are safe to evaluate or update watchpoint B.
990 Watchpoints on local expressions need to be evaluated in the
991 context of the thread that was current when the watchpoint was
992 created, and, that thread needs to be stopped to be able to select
993 the correct frame context. Watchpoints on global expressions can
994 be evaluated on any thread, and in any state. It is presently left
995 to the target allowing memory accesses when threads are
996 running. */
997
998 static int
999 watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct breakpoint *b)
1000 {
1001 return (ptid_equal (b->watchpoint_thread, null_ptid)
1002 || (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, b->watchpoint_thread)
1003 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid)));
1004 }
1005
1006 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
1007 - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
1008 - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
1009 - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
1010 in b->loc->cond.
1011 - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
1012
1013 If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do nothing.
1014 If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete it.
1015
1016 Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are removed
1017 + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must never be removed
1018 because they might be missed by a running thread when debugging in non-stop
1019 mode. On the other hand, hardware watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint;
1020 processed here) are specific to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's
1021 hardware debug registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in
1022 order to be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
1023
1024 Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being presented to the
1025 user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would reset the data used to
1026 present the watchpoint hit to the user. And it must not be done later
1027 because it could display the same single watchpoint hit during multiple GDB
1028 stops. Note that the latter is relevant only to the hardware watchpoint
1029 types bp_read_watchpoint and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by
1030 bp_hardware_watchpoint is not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the
1031 memory content has not changed.
1032
1033 The following constraints influence the location where we can reset hardware
1034 watchpoints:
1035
1036 * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are called
1037 several times when GDB stops.
1038
1039 [linux]
1040 * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time, causing GDB to
1041 stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint hit at a time as the
1042 reason for stopping, and all the other hits are presented later, one after
1043 the other, each time the user requests the execution to be resumed.
1044 Execution is not resumed for the threads still having pending hit event
1045 stored in LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from
1046 the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being reported
1047 from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address until the real
1048 thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets presented and thus its
1049 LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
1050
1051 Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the watchpoint
1052 removal from inferior. */
1053
1054 static void
1055 update_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, int reparse)
1056 {
1057 int within_current_scope;
1058 struct frame_id saved_frame_id;
1059 struct bp_location *loc;
1060 int frame_saved;
1061 bpstat bs;
1062
1063 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
1064 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
1065 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
1066 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
1067 return;
1068
1069 /* We don't free locations. They are stored in bp_location array and
1070 update_global_locations will eventually delete them and remove
1071 breakpoints if needed. */
1072 b->loc = NULL;
1073
1074 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1075 return;
1076
1077 frame_saved = 0;
1078
1079 /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */
1080 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
1081 within_current_scope = 1;
1082 else
1083 {
1084 struct frame_info *fi;
1085
1086 /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
1087 evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */
1088 /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
1089 took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
1090 selected frame. */
1091 frame_saved = 1;
1092 saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1093
1094 fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
1095 within_current_scope = (fi != NULL);
1096 if (within_current_scope)
1097 select_frame (fi);
1098 }
1099
1100 if (within_current_scope && reparse)
1101 {
1102 char *s;
1103 if (b->exp)
1104 {
1105 xfree (b->exp);
1106 b->exp = NULL;
1107 }
1108 s = b->exp_string;
1109 b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1110 /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
1111 no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
1112 to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
1113 be completely different objects. */
1114 value_free (b->val);
1115 b->val = NULL;
1116 b->val_valid = 0;
1117 }
1118
1119 /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
1120 it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
1121 don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete
1122 such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
1123 is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */
1124 if ( !target_has_execution)
1125 {
1126 /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and
1127 set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when
1128 the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */
1129 }
1130 else if (within_current_scope && b->exp)
1131 {
1132 struct value *val_chain, *v, *result, *next;
1133 struct program_space *frame_pspace;
1134
1135 fetch_watchpoint_value (b->exp, &v, &result, &val_chain);
1136
1137 /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of
1138 b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
1139 it only if we reported that last value to user. As it
1140 happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly. */
1141 if (!b->val_valid)
1142 {
1143 b->val = v;
1144 b->val_valid = 1;
1145 }
1146
1147 /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or an
1148 ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support and free
1149 hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior is started. */
1150 if ((b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
1151 && reparse)
1152 {
1153 int i, mem_cnt, other_type_used;
1154
1155 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count (bp_hardware_watchpoint,
1156 &other_type_used);
1157 mem_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain);
1158
1159 if (!mem_cnt)
1160 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1161 else
1162 {
1163 int target_resources_ok = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint
1164 (bp_hardware_watchpoint, i + mem_cnt, other_type_used);
1165 if (target_resources_ok <= 0)
1166 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1167 else
1168 b->type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
1169 }
1170 }
1171
1172 frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1173
1174 /* Look at each value on the value chain. */
1175 for (v = val_chain; v; v = next)
1176 {
1177 /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
1178 its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
1179 must watch it. If the first value returned is
1180 still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
1181 watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */
1182 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory
1183 && (v == val_chain || ! value_lazy (v)))
1184 {
1185 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
1186
1187 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
1188 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
1189 appear in the middle of some value chain. */
1190 if (v == result
1191 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1192 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
1193 {
1194 CORE_ADDR addr;
1195 int len, type;
1196 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
1197
1198 addr = value_address (v);
1199 len = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
1200 type = hw_write;
1201 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
1202 type = hw_read;
1203 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
1204 type = hw_access;
1205
1206 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1207 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
1208 ;
1209 *tmp = loc;
1210 loc->gdbarch = get_type_arch (value_type (v));
1211
1212 loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1213 loc->address = addr;
1214 loc->length = len;
1215 loc->watchpoint_type = type;
1216 }
1217 }
1218
1219 next = value_next (v);
1220 if (v != b->val)
1221 value_free (v);
1222 }
1223
1224 /* We just regenerated the list of breakpoint locations.
1225 The new location does not have its condition field set to anything
1226 and therefore, we must always reparse the cond_string, independently
1227 of the value of the reparse flag. */
1228 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
1229 {
1230 char *s = b->cond_string;
1231 b->loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1232 }
1233 }
1234 else if (!within_current_scope)
1235 {
1236 printf_filtered (_("\
1237 Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block \n\
1238 in which its expression is valid.\n"),
1239 b->number);
1240 if (b->related_breakpoint)
1241 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1242 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1243 }
1244
1245 /* Restore the selected frame. */
1246 if (frame_saved)
1247 select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id));
1248 }
1249
1250
1251 /* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
1252 inserted in the inferior. */
1253 static int
1254 should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bpt)
1255 {
1256 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner))
1257 return 0;
1258
1259 if (bpt->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1260 return 0;
1261
1262 if (!bpt->enabled || bpt->shlib_disabled || bpt->duplicate)
1263 return 0;
1264
1265 /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
1266 vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running
1267 free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
1268 OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
1269 that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared
1270 memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
1271 the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since
1272 the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */
1273 if (bpt->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed)
1274 return 0;
1275
1276 /* Tracepoints are inserted by the target at a time of its choosing,
1277 not by us. */
1278 if (bpt->owner->type == bp_tracepoint)
1279 return 0;
1280
1281 return 1;
1282 }
1283
1284 /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BPT is the breakpoint.
1285 Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and DISABLED_BREAKS,
1286 and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
1287
1288 NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an object-style
1289 method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */
1290 static int
1291 insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bpt,
1292 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream,
1293 int *disabled_breaks,
1294 int *hw_breakpoint_error)
1295 {
1296 int val = 0;
1297
1298 if (!should_be_inserted (bpt) || bpt->inserted)
1299 return 0;
1300
1301 /* Initialize the target-specific information. */
1302 memset (&bpt->target_info, 0, sizeof (bpt->target_info));
1303 bpt->target_info.placed_address = bpt->address;
1304 bpt->target_info.placed_address_space = bpt->pspace->aspace;
1305
1306 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
1307 || bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1308 {
1309 if (bpt->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
1310 {
1311 /* If the explicitly specified breakpoint type
1312 is not hardware breakpoint, check the memory map to see
1313 if the breakpoint address is in read only memory or not.
1314 Two important cases are:
1315 - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory
1316 is readonly. We change the type of the location to
1317 hardware breakpoint.
1318 - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is read-write.
1319 This means we've previously made the location hardware one, but
1320 then the memory map changed, so we undo.
1321
1322 When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will
1323 use location types we've just set here, the only possible
1324 problem is that memory map has changed during running program,
1325 but it's not going to work anyway with current gdb. */
1326 struct mem_region *mr
1327 = lookup_mem_region (bpt->target_info.placed_address);
1328
1329 if (mr)
1330 {
1331 if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints)
1332 {
1333 int changed = 0;
1334 enum bp_loc_type new_type;
1335
1336 if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
1337 new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
1338 else
1339 new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
1340
1341 if (new_type != bpt->loc_type)
1342 {
1343 static int said = 0;
1344 bpt->loc_type = new_type;
1345 if (!said)
1346 {
1347 fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout, _("\
1348 Note: automatically using hardware breakpoints for read-only addresses.\n"));
1349 said = 1;
1350 }
1351 }
1352 }
1353 else if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
1354 && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
1355 warning (_("cannot set software breakpoint at readonly address %s"),
1356 paddress (bpt->gdbarch, bpt->address));
1357 }
1358 }
1359
1360 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
1361 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
1362 || bpt->section == NULL
1363 || !(section_is_overlay (bpt->section)))
1364 {
1365 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
1366
1367 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1368 val = target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1369 &bpt->target_info);
1370 else
1371 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1372 &bpt->target_info);
1373 }
1374 else
1375 {
1376 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
1377 Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
1378 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
1379 {
1380 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
1381 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
1382 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */
1383 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1384 warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
1385 bpt->owner->number);
1386 else
1387 {
1388 CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bpt->address,
1389 bpt->section);
1390 /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */
1391 bpt->overlay_target_info = bpt->target_info;
1392 bpt->overlay_target_info.placed_address = addr;
1393 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1394 &bpt->overlay_target_info);
1395 if (val != 0)
1396 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1397 "Overlay breakpoint %d failed: in ROM?\n",
1398 bpt->owner->number);
1399 }
1400 }
1401 /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
1402 if (section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
1403 {
1404 /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */
1405 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1406 val = target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1407 &bpt->target_info);
1408 else
1409 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1410 &bpt->target_info);
1411 }
1412 else
1413 {
1414 /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted.
1415 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */
1416 return 0;
1417 }
1418 }
1419
1420 if (val)
1421 {
1422 /* Can't set the breakpoint. */
1423 if (solib_name_from_address (bpt->pspace, bpt->address))
1424 {
1425 /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
1426 val = 0;
1427 bpt->shlib_disabled = 1;
1428 if (!*disabled_breaks)
1429 {
1430 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1431 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
1432 bpt->owner->number);
1433 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1434 "Temporarily disabling shared library breakpoints:\n");
1435 }
1436 *disabled_breaks = 1;
1437 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1438 "breakpoint #%d\n", bpt->owner->number);
1439 }
1440 else
1441 {
1442 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1443 {
1444 *hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
1445 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1446 "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d.\n",
1447 bpt->owner->number);
1448 }
1449 else
1450 {
1451 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1452 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
1453 bpt->owner->number);
1454 fprintf_filtered (tmp_error_stream,
1455 "Error accessing memory address ");
1456 fputs_filtered (paddress (bpt->gdbarch, bpt->address),
1457 tmp_error_stream);
1458 fprintf_filtered (tmp_error_stream, ": %s.\n",
1459 safe_strerror (val));
1460 }
1461
1462 }
1463 }
1464 else
1465 bpt->inserted = 1;
1466
1467 return val;
1468 }
1469
1470 else if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
1471 /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
1472 watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */
1473 && bpt->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
1474 {
1475 val = target_insert_watchpoint (bpt->address,
1476 bpt->length,
1477 bpt->watchpoint_type);
1478 bpt->inserted = (val != -1);
1479 }
1480
1481 else if (bpt->owner->type == bp_catchpoint)
1482 {
1483 struct gdb_exception e = catch_exception (uiout, insert_catchpoint,
1484 bpt->owner, RETURN_MASK_ERROR);
1485 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, "warning: inserting catchpoint %d: ",
1486 bpt->owner->number);
1487 if (e.reason < 0)
1488 bpt->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled;
1489 else
1490 bpt->inserted = 1;
1491
1492 /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
1493 inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
1494 so just return success. */
1495 return 0;
1496 }
1497
1498 return 0;
1499 }
1500
1501 /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
1502 deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
1503 PSPACE anymore. */
1504
1505 void
1506 breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace)
1507 {
1508 struct breakpoint *b, *b_temp;
1509 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
1510
1511 /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */
1512 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_temp)
1513 {
1514 if (b->pspace == pspace)
1515 delete_breakpoint (b);
1516 }
1517
1518 /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
1519 bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */
1520 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
1521 {
1522 struct bp_location *tmp;
1523
1524 if (loc->pspace == pspace)
1525 {
1526 if (loc->owner->loc == loc)
1527 loc->owner->loc = loc->next;
1528 else
1529 for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next)
1530 if (tmp->next == loc)
1531 {
1532 tmp->next = loc->next;
1533 break;
1534 }
1535 }
1536 }
1537
1538 /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
1539 removed locations above. */
1540 update_global_location_list (0);
1541 }
1542
1543 /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
1544 Throws exception on any error.
1545 A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
1546 again, so calling this function twice is safe. */
1547 void
1548 insert_breakpoints (void)
1549 {
1550 struct breakpoint *bpt;
1551
1552 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
1553 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
1554 update_watchpoint (bpt, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
1555
1556 update_global_location_list (1);
1557
1558 /* update_global_location_list does not insert breakpoints when
1559 always_inserted_mode is not enabled. Explicitly insert them
1560 now. */
1561 if (!breakpoints_always_inserted_mode ())
1562 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
1563 }
1564
1565 /* insert_breakpoints is used when starting or continuing the program.
1566 remove_breakpoints is used when the program stops.
1567 Both return zero if successful,
1568 or an `errno' value if could not write the inferior. */
1569
1570 static void
1571 insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
1572 {
1573 struct breakpoint *bpt;
1574 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1575 int error = 0;
1576 int val = 0;
1577 int disabled_breaks = 0;
1578 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
1579
1580 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
1581 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
1582
1583 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
1584 there was an error. */
1585 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "Warning:\n");
1586
1587 save_current_space_and_thread ();
1588
1589 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1590 {
1591 struct thread_info *tp;
1592 CORE_ADDR last_addr;
1593
1594 if (!should_be_inserted (b) || b->inserted)
1595 continue;
1596
1597 /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if the
1598 thread no longer exists. */
1599 if (b->owner->thread != -1
1600 && !valid_thread_id (b->owner->thread))
1601 continue;
1602
1603 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
1604
1605 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
1606 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
1607 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
1608 insert breakpoints. */
1609 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
1610 && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
1611 continue;
1612
1613 val = insert_bp_location (b, tmp_error_stream,
1614 &disabled_breaks,
1615 &hw_breakpoint_error);
1616 if (val)
1617 error = val;
1618 }
1619
1620 /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint,
1621 remove them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */
1622 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
1623 {
1624 int some_failed = 0;
1625 struct bp_location *loc;
1626
1627 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
1628 continue;
1629
1630 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
1631 continue;
1632
1633 if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1634 continue;
1635
1636 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1637 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
1638 {
1639 some_failed = 1;
1640 break;
1641 }
1642 if (some_failed)
1643 {
1644 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1645 if (loc->inserted)
1646 remove_breakpoint (loc, mark_uninserted);
1647
1648 hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
1649 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1650 "Could not insert hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
1651 bpt->number);
1652 error = -1;
1653 }
1654 }
1655
1656 if (error)
1657 {
1658 /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
1659 message about possibly exhausted resources. */
1660 if (hw_breakpoint_error)
1661 {
1662 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1663 "Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
1664 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
1665 }
1666 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
1667 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
1668 }
1669
1670 do_cleanups (cleanups);
1671 }
1672
1673 int
1674 remove_breakpoints (void)
1675 {
1676 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1677 int val = 0;
1678
1679 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1680 {
1681 if (b->inserted)
1682 val |= remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
1683 }
1684 return val;
1685 }
1686
1687 /* Remove breakpoints of process PID. */
1688
1689 int
1690 remove_breakpoints_pid (int pid)
1691 {
1692 struct bp_location *b, **b_tmp;
1693 int val;
1694 struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
1695
1696 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, b_tmp)
1697 {
1698 if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
1699 continue;
1700
1701 if (b->inserted)
1702 {
1703 val = remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
1704 if (val != 0)
1705 return val;
1706 }
1707 }
1708 return 0;
1709 }
1710
1711 int
1712 remove_hw_watchpoints (void)
1713 {
1714 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1715 int val = 0;
1716
1717 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1718 {
1719 if (b->inserted && b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
1720 val |= remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
1721 }
1722 return val;
1723 }
1724
1725 int
1726 reattach_breakpoints (int pid)
1727 {
1728 struct cleanup *old_chain;
1729 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1730 int val;
1731 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
1732 int dummy1 = 0, dummy2 = 0;
1733 struct inferior *inf;
1734 struct thread_info *tp;
1735
1736 tp = any_live_thread_of_process (pid);
1737 if (tp == NULL)
1738 return 1;
1739
1740 inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
1741 old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
1742
1743 inferior_ptid = tp->ptid;
1744
1745 make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
1746
1747 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1748 {
1749 if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
1750 continue;
1751
1752 if (b->inserted)
1753 {
1754 b->inserted = 0;
1755 val = insert_bp_location (b, tmp_error_stream,
1756 &dummy1, &dummy2);
1757 if (val != 0)
1758 {
1759 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1760 return val;
1761 }
1762 }
1763 }
1764 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1765 return 0;
1766 }
1767
1768 static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1;
1769
1770 static struct breakpoint *
1771 create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
1772 CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type)
1773 {
1774 struct symtab_and_line sal;
1775 struct breakpoint *b;
1776
1777 init_sal (&sal); /* initialize to zeroes */
1778
1779 sal.pc = address;
1780 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
1781 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
1782
1783 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
1784 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
1785 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
1786
1787 return b;
1788 }
1789
1790 static void
1791 create_overlay_event_breakpoint (char *func_name)
1792 {
1793 struct objfile *objfile;
1794
1795 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
1796 {
1797 struct breakpoint *b;
1798 struct minimal_symbol *m;
1799
1800 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
1801 if (m == NULL)
1802 continue;
1803
1804 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile),
1805 SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (m),
1806 bp_overlay_event);
1807 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
1808
1809 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto)
1810 {
1811 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
1812 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
1813 }
1814 else
1815 {
1816 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
1817 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
1818 }
1819 }
1820 update_global_location_list (1);
1821 }
1822
1823 static void
1824 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (char *func_name)
1825 {
1826 struct program_space *pspace;
1827 struct objfile *objfile;
1828 struct cleanup *old_chain;
1829
1830 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
1831
1832 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
1833 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
1834 {
1835 struct breakpoint *b;
1836 struct minimal_symbol *m;
1837
1838 if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (get_objfile_arch (objfile)))
1839 continue;
1840
1841 set_current_program_space (pspace);
1842
1843 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
1844 if (m == NULL)
1845 continue;
1846
1847 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile),
1848 SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (m),
1849 bp_longjmp_master);
1850 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
1851 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
1852 }
1853 update_global_location_list (1);
1854
1855 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1856 }
1857
1858 void
1859 update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
1860 {
1861 struct breakpoint *b;
1862 struct breakpoint *temp;
1863 struct bp_location *bploc, **bplocp_tmp;
1864
1865 /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the
1866 INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
1867 writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The
1868 "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
1869 do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking
1870 breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that
1871 here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
1872 breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */
1873 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bploc, bplocp_tmp)
1874 if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space)
1875 gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted);
1876
1877 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
1878 {
1879 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
1880 continue;
1881
1882 /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
1883 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
1884 {
1885 delete_breakpoint (b);
1886 continue;
1887 }
1888
1889 /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
1890 if (b->type == bp_jit_event)
1891 {
1892 delete_breakpoint (b);
1893 continue;
1894 }
1895
1896 /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
1897 as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */
1898 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
1899 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
1900 {
1901 delete_breakpoint (b);
1902 continue;
1903 }
1904
1905 /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
1906 if (b->type == bp_step_resume)
1907 {
1908 delete_breakpoint (b);
1909 continue;
1910 }
1911
1912 /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
1913 after an exec. */
1914 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume)
1915 {
1916 delete_breakpoint (b);
1917 continue;
1918 }
1919
1920 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
1921 {
1922 /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
1923 do anything at this point. In the future, if some of
1924 the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
1925 a new method, and call this method from here. */
1926 continue;
1927 }
1928
1929 /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able
1930 to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
1931 caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just
1932 carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
1933 a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish
1934 will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
1935
1936 We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But
1937 we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
1938 the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a
1939 chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
1940 here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
1941 gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
1942 We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
1943
1944 In the absense of a general solution for the "how do we know
1945 it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
1946 problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
1947 let finish_command delete it.
1948
1949 (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
1950 momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
1951 the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's
1952 address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
1953 solib breakpoints.) */
1954
1955 if (b->type == bp_finish)
1956 {
1957 continue;
1958 }
1959
1960 /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
1961 pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
1962 a.out. */
1963 if (b->addr_string == NULL)
1964 {
1965 delete_breakpoint (b);
1966 continue;
1967 }
1968 }
1969 /* FIXME what about longjmp breakpoints? Re-create them here? */
1970 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ("_ovly_debug_event");
1971 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("longjmp");
1972 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_longjmp");
1973 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("siglongjmp");
1974 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_siglongjmp");
1975 }
1976
1977 int
1978 detach_breakpoints (int pid)
1979 {
1980 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1981 int val = 0;
1982 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
1983 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
1984
1985 if (pid == PIDGET (inferior_ptid))
1986 error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
1987
1988 /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */
1989 inferior_ptid = pid_to_ptid (pid);
1990 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1991 {
1992 if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
1993 continue;
1994
1995 if (b->inserted)
1996 val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (b, mark_inserted);
1997 }
1998 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1999 return val;
2000 }
2001
2002 /* Remove the breakpoint location B from the current address space.
2003 Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
2004 When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
2005 do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
2006 *not* look at b->pspace->aspace here. */
2007
2008 static int
2009 remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *b, insertion_state_t is)
2010 {
2011 int val;
2012 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2013
2014 if (b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2015 /* Permanent breakpoints cannot be inserted or removed. */
2016 return 0;
2017
2018 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
2019 This should not ever happen. */
2020 gdb_assert (b->owner->type != bp_none);
2021
2022 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2023 || b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2024 {
2025 /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
2026 trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
2027 bp_hardware_breakpoint. */
2028
2029 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
2030 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
2031 || b->section == NULL
2032 || !(section_is_overlay (b->section)))
2033 {
2034 /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */
2035
2036 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2037 val = target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch, &b->target_info);
2038 else
2039 val = target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch, &b->target_info);
2040 }
2041 else
2042 {
2043 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
2044 Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
2045 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
2046 {
2047 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
2048 should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it.
2049 */
2050 /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
2051 have already warned when we failed to insert it. */
2052 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2053 target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2054 &b->overlay_target_info);
2055 else
2056 target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2057 &b->overlay_target_info);
2058 }
2059 /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
2060 If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */
2061 if (b->inserted)
2062 {
2063 /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to
2064 remove the breakpoint if the section had been
2065 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We
2066 don't know what the overlay manager might do. */
2067 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2068 val = target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2069 &b->target_info);
2070
2071 /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
2072 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
2073 wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */
2074 else if (section_is_mapped (b->section))
2075 val = target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2076 &b->target_info);
2077 else
2078 val = 0;
2079 }
2080 else
2081 {
2082 /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */
2083 val = 0;
2084 }
2085 }
2086
2087 /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint
2088 in a shared library that has already been removed, but we
2089 have not yet processed the shlib unload event. */
2090 if (val && solib_name_from_address (b->pspace, b->address))
2091 val = 0;
2092
2093 if (val)
2094 return val;
2095 b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2096 }
2097 else if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
2098 {
2099 struct value *v;
2100 struct value *n;
2101
2102 b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2103 val = target_remove_watchpoint (b->address, b->length,
2104 b->watchpoint_type);
2105
2106 /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */
2107 if ((is == mark_uninserted) && (b->inserted))
2108 warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
2109 b->owner->number);
2110 }
2111 else if (b->owner->type == bp_catchpoint
2112 && breakpoint_enabled (b->owner)
2113 && !b->duplicate)
2114 {
2115 gdb_assert (b->owner->ops != NULL && b->owner->ops->remove != NULL);
2116
2117 val = b->owner->ops->remove (b->owner);
2118 if (val)
2119 return val;
2120 b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2121 }
2122
2123 return 0;
2124 }
2125
2126 static int
2127 remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *b, insertion_state_t is)
2128 {
2129 int ret;
2130 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2131
2132 if (b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2133 /* Permanent breakpoints cannot be inserted or removed. */
2134 return 0;
2135
2136 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
2137 This should not ever happen. */
2138 gdb_assert (b->owner->type != bp_none);
2139
2140 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
2141
2142 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
2143
2144 ret = remove_breakpoint_1 (b, is);
2145
2146 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2147 return ret;
2148 }
2149
2150 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */
2151
2152 void
2153 mark_breakpoints_out (void)
2154 {
2155 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2156
2157 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2158 if (bpt->pspace == current_program_space)
2159 bpt->inserted = 0;
2160 }
2161
2162 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
2163 breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
2164
2165 Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
2166 between runs.
2167
2168 Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
2169 generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
2170 init_wait_for_inferior). */
2171
2172
2173
2174 void
2175 breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context)
2176 {
2177 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
2178 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2179 int ix;
2180 struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space;
2181
2182 /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
2183 nothing to do. */
2184 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch))
2185 return;
2186
2187 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2188 {
2189 if (bpt->pspace == pspace
2190 && bpt->owner->enable_state != bp_permanent)
2191 bpt->inserted = 0;
2192 }
2193
2194 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
2195 {
2196 if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace)
2197 continue;
2198
2199 switch (b->type)
2200 {
2201 case bp_call_dummy:
2202 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
2203
2204 /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
2205 cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better
2206 get rid of it.
2207
2208 Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */
2209 delete_breakpoint (b);
2210 break;
2211
2212 case bp_watchpoint:
2213 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
2214 case bp_read_watchpoint:
2215 case bp_access_watchpoint:
2216
2217 /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */
2218 if (b->exp_valid_block != NULL)
2219 delete_breakpoint (b);
2220 else if (context == inf_starting)
2221 {
2222 /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value
2223 in insert_breakpoints. */
2224 if (b->val)
2225 value_free (b->val);
2226 b->val = NULL;
2227 b->val_valid = 0;
2228 }
2229 break;
2230 default:
2231 break;
2232 }
2233 }
2234
2235 /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */
2236 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, bpt); ++ix)
2237 free_bp_location (bpt);
2238 VEC_free (bp_location_p, moribund_locations);
2239 }
2240
2241 /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
2242 target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
2243 we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
2244 match, not program space. */
2245
2246 /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
2247 exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
2248 ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
2249 permanent breakpoint.
2250 - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
2251 actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
2252 - When continuing from a localion with a permanent breakpoint, we
2253 need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
2254 the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */
2255
2256 enum breakpoint_here
2257 breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2258 {
2259 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2260 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
2261
2262 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2263 {
2264 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2265 && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2266 continue;
2267
2268 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner)
2269 || bpt->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2270 && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2271 aspace, pc))
2272 {
2273 if (overlay_debugging
2274 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2275 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2276 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2277 else if (bpt->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2278 return permanent_breakpoint_here;
2279 else
2280 any_breakpoint_here = 1;
2281 }
2282 }
2283
2284 return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : 0;
2285 }
2286
2287 /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */
2288
2289 int
2290 moribund_breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2291 {
2292 struct bp_location *loc;
2293 int ix;
2294
2295 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
2296 if (breakpoint_address_match (loc->pspace->aspace, loc->address,
2297 aspace, pc))
2298 return 1;
2299
2300 return 0;
2301 }
2302
2303 /* Returns non-zero if there's a breakpoint inserted at PC, which is
2304 inserted using regular breakpoint_chain / bp_location array mechanism.
2305 This does not check for single-step breakpoints, which are
2306 inserted and removed using direct target manipulation. */
2307
2308 int
2309 regular_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2310 {
2311 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2312
2313 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2314 {
2315 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2316 && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2317 continue;
2318
2319 if (bpt->inserted
2320 && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2321 aspace, pc))
2322 {
2323 if (overlay_debugging
2324 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2325 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2326 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2327 else
2328 return 1;
2329 }
2330 }
2331 return 0;
2332 }
2333
2334 /* Returns non-zero iff there's either regular breakpoint
2335 or a single step breakpoint inserted at PC. */
2336
2337 int
2338 breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2339 {
2340 if (regular_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2341 return 1;
2342
2343 if (single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2344 return 1;
2345
2346 return 0;
2347 }
2348
2349 /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
2350 inserted at PC. */
2351
2352 int
2353 software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2354 {
2355 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2356 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
2357
2358 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2359 {
2360 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
2361 continue;
2362
2363 if (bpt->inserted
2364 && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2365 aspace, pc))
2366 {
2367 if (overlay_debugging
2368 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2369 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2370 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2371 else
2372 return 1;
2373 }
2374 }
2375
2376 /* Also check for software single-step breakpoints. */
2377 if (single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2378 return 1;
2379
2380 return 0;
2381 }
2382
2383 int
2384 hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (struct address_space *aspace,
2385 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
2386 {
2387 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2388
2389 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
2390 {
2391 struct bp_location *loc;
2392
2393 if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
2394 && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
2395 continue;
2396
2397 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
2398 continue;
2399
2400 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
2401 if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted)
2402 {
2403 CORE_ADDR l, h;
2404
2405 /* Check for intersection. */
2406 l = max (loc->address, addr);
2407 h = min (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len);
2408 if (l < h)
2409 return 1;
2410 }
2411 }
2412 return 0;
2413 }
2414
2415 /* breakpoint_thread_match (PC, PTID) returns true if the breakpoint at
2416 PC is valid for process/thread PTID. */
2417
2418 int
2419 breakpoint_thread_match (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
2420 ptid_t ptid)
2421 {
2422 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2423 /* The thread and task IDs associated to PTID, computed lazily. */
2424 int thread = -1;
2425 int task = 0;
2426
2427 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2428 {
2429 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2430 && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2431 continue;
2432
2433 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner)
2434 && bpt->owner->enable_state != bp_permanent)
2435 continue;
2436
2437 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2438 aspace, pc))
2439 continue;
2440
2441 if (bpt->owner->thread != -1)
2442 {
2443 /* This is a thread-specific breakpoint. Check that ptid
2444 matches that thread. If thread hasn't been computed yet,
2445 it is now time to do so. */
2446 if (thread == -1)
2447 thread = pid_to_thread_id (ptid);
2448 if (bpt->owner->thread != thread)
2449 continue;
2450 }
2451
2452 if (bpt->owner->task != 0)
2453 {
2454 /* This is a task-specific breakpoint. Check that ptid
2455 matches that task. If task hasn't been computed yet,
2456 it is now time to do so. */
2457 if (task == 0)
2458 task = ada_get_task_number (ptid);
2459 if (bpt->owner->task != task)
2460 continue;
2461 }
2462
2463 if (overlay_debugging
2464 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2465 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2466 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2467
2468 return 1;
2469 }
2470
2471 return 0;
2472 }
2473 \f
2474
2475 /* bpstat stuff. External routines' interfaces are documented
2476 in breakpoint.h. */
2477
2478 int
2479 ep_is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *ep)
2480 {
2481 return (ep->type == bp_catchpoint);
2482 }
2483
2484 void
2485 bpstat_free (bpstat bs)
2486 {
2487 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2488 value_free (bs->old_val);
2489 free_command_lines (&bs->commands);
2490 xfree (bs);
2491 }
2492
2493 /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
2494 Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */
2495
2496 void
2497 bpstat_clear (bpstat *bsp)
2498 {
2499 bpstat p;
2500 bpstat q;
2501
2502 if (bsp == 0)
2503 return;
2504 p = *bsp;
2505 while (p != NULL)
2506 {
2507 q = p->next;
2508 bpstat_free (p);
2509 p = q;
2510 }
2511 *bsp = NULL;
2512 }
2513
2514 /* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
2515 is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */
2516
2517 bpstat
2518 bpstat_copy (bpstat bs)
2519 {
2520 bpstat p = NULL;
2521 bpstat tmp;
2522 bpstat retval = NULL;
2523
2524 if (bs == NULL)
2525 return bs;
2526
2527 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2528 {
2529 tmp = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*tmp));
2530 memcpy (tmp, bs, sizeof (*tmp));
2531 if (bs->commands != NULL)
2532 tmp->commands = copy_command_lines (bs->commands);
2533 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2534 {
2535 tmp->old_val = value_copy (bs->old_val);
2536 release_value (tmp->old_val);
2537 }
2538
2539 if (p == NULL)
2540 /* This is the first thing in the chain. */
2541 retval = tmp;
2542 else
2543 p->next = tmp;
2544 p = tmp;
2545 }
2546 p->next = NULL;
2547 return retval;
2548 }
2549
2550 /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint */
2551
2552 bpstat
2553 bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint)
2554 {
2555 if (bsp == NULL)
2556 return NULL;
2557
2558 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
2559 {
2560 if (bsp->breakpoint_at && bsp->breakpoint_at->owner == breakpoint)
2561 return bsp;
2562 }
2563 return NULL;
2564 }
2565
2566 /* Find a step_resume breakpoint associated with this bpstat.
2567 (If there are multiple step_resume bp's on the list, this function
2568 will arbitrarily pick one.)
2569
2570 It is an error to use this function if BPSTAT doesn't contain a
2571 step_resume breakpoint.
2572
2573 See wait_for_inferior's use of this function. */
2574 struct breakpoint *
2575 bpstat_find_step_resume_breakpoint (bpstat bsp)
2576 {
2577 int current_thread;
2578
2579 gdb_assert (bsp != NULL);
2580
2581 current_thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
2582
2583 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
2584 {
2585 if ((bsp->breakpoint_at != NULL)
2586 && (bsp->breakpoint_at->owner->type == bp_step_resume)
2587 && (bsp->breakpoint_at->owner->thread == current_thread
2588 || bsp->breakpoint_at->owner->thread == -1))
2589 return bsp->breakpoint_at->owner;
2590 }
2591
2592 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("No step_resume breakpoint found."));
2593 }
2594
2595
2596 /* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are stopped
2597 at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the remaining
2598 breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be good for
2599 anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
2600 Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
2601 Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
2602 we set it.
2603 Return 1 otherwise. */
2604
2605 int
2606 bpstat_num (bpstat *bsp, int *num)
2607 {
2608 struct breakpoint *b;
2609
2610 if ((*bsp) == NULL)
2611 return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */
2612
2613 /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that
2614 correspond to a single breakpoint -- otherwise,
2615 this function might return the same number more
2616 than once and this will look ugly. */
2617 b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at ? (*bsp)->breakpoint_at->owner : NULL;
2618 *bsp = (*bsp)->next;
2619 if (b == NULL)
2620 return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
2621
2622 *num = b->number; /* We have its number */
2623 return 1;
2624 }
2625
2626 /* Modify BS so that the actions will not be performed. */
2627
2628 void
2629 bpstat_clear_actions (bpstat bs)
2630 {
2631 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2632 {
2633 free_command_lines (&bs->commands);
2634 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2635 {
2636 value_free (bs->old_val);
2637 bs->old_val = NULL;
2638 }
2639 }
2640 }
2641
2642 /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */
2643
2644 static void
2645 breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
2646 {
2647 if (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
2648 {
2649 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
2650
2651 /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
2652 interrupt the command list. When the call finishes
2653 successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
2654 breakpoint as if nothing happened. */
2655 if (tp->in_infcall)
2656 return;
2657 }
2658
2659 breakpoint_proceeded = 1;
2660 }
2661
2662 /* Stub for cleaning up our state if we error-out of a breakpoint command */
2663 static void
2664 cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *ignore)
2665 {
2666 executing_breakpoint_commands = 0;
2667 }
2668
2669 /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at this
2670 location. Any of these commands could cause the process to proceed
2671 beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by checking
2672 the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
2673
2674 Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that
2675 case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
2676 bpstat of the current thread. */
2677
2678 static int
2679 bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat *bsp)
2680 {
2681 bpstat bs;
2682 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2683 int again = 0;
2684
2685 /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
2686 in bs->commands. */
2687 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
2688 return 0;
2689
2690 executing_breakpoint_commands = 1;
2691 old_chain = make_cleanup (cleanup_executing_breakpoints, 0);
2692
2693 /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
2694 bs = *bsp;
2695
2696 breakpoint_proceeded = 0;
2697 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2698 {
2699 struct command_line *cmd;
2700 struct cleanup *this_cmd_tree_chain;
2701
2702 /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
2703
2704 The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
2705 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
2706 frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't
2707 free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
2708 take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's
2709 commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
2710 can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
2711 the tree when we're done. */
2712 cmd = bs->commands;
2713 bs->commands = 0;
2714 this_cmd_tree_chain = make_cleanup_free_command_lines (&cmd);
2715
2716 while (cmd != NULL)
2717 {
2718 execute_control_command (cmd);
2719
2720 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
2721 break;
2722 else
2723 cmd = cmd->next;
2724 }
2725
2726 /* We can free this command tree now. */
2727 do_cleanups (this_cmd_tree_chain);
2728
2729 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
2730 {
2731 if (target_can_async_p ())
2732 /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
2733 running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
2734 us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */
2735 ;
2736 else
2737 /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
2738 we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
2739 Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
2740 execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
2741 only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
2742 involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we
2743 can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be
2744 noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
2745 not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
2746 invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
2747 command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we
2748 return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
2749 with the new stop_bpstat. */
2750 again = 1;
2751 break;
2752 }
2753 }
2754 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2755 return again;
2756 }
2757
2758 void
2759 bpstat_do_actions (void)
2760 {
2761 /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */
2762 while (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid)
2763 && target_has_execution
2764 && !is_exited (inferior_ptid)
2765 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid))
2766 /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the inferior,
2767 and only return when it is stopped at the next breakpoint, we
2768 keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns false to
2769 indicate the inferior was not resumed. */
2770 if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&inferior_thread ()->stop_bpstat))
2771 break;
2772 }
2773
2774 /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */
2775
2776 static void
2777 watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream)
2778 {
2779 if (val == NULL)
2780 fprintf_unfiltered (stream, _("<unreadable>"));
2781 else
2782 {
2783 struct value_print_options opts;
2784 get_user_print_options (&opts);
2785 value_print (val, stream, &opts);
2786 }
2787 }
2788
2789 /* This is the normal print function for a bpstat. In the future,
2790 much of this logic could (should?) be moved to bpstat_stop_status,
2791 by having it set different print_it values.
2792
2793 Current scheme: When we stop, bpstat_print() is called. It loops
2794 through the bpstat list of things causing this stop, calling the
2795 print_bp_stop_message function on each one. The behavior of the
2796 print_bp_stop_message function depends on the print_it field of
2797 bpstat. If such field so indicates, call this function here.
2798
2799 Return values from this routine (ultimately used by bpstat_print()
2800 and normal_stop() to decide what to do):
2801 PRINT_NOTHING: Means we already printed all we needed to print,
2802 don't print anything else.
2803 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, and we do *not* desire
2804 that something to be followed by a location.
2805 PRINT_SCR_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and we *do* desire
2806 that something to be followed by a location.
2807 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing or we need to do some more
2808 analysis. */
2809
2810 static enum print_stop_action
2811 print_it_typical (bpstat bs)
2812 {
2813 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2814 struct breakpoint *b;
2815 const struct bp_location *bl;
2816 struct ui_stream *stb;
2817 int bp_temp = 0;
2818 enum print_stop_action result;
2819
2820 /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
2821 which has since been deleted. */
2822 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
2823 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2824 bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
2825 b = bl->owner;
2826
2827 stb = ui_out_stream_new (uiout);
2828 old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_stream_delete (stb);
2829
2830 switch (b->type)
2831 {
2832 case bp_breakpoint:
2833 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
2834 bp_temp = bs->breakpoint_at->owner->disposition == disp_del;
2835 if (bl->address != bl->requested_address)
2836 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address,
2837 bl->address,
2838 b->number, 1);
2839 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
2840 if (bp_temp)
2841 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary breakpoint ");
2842 else
2843 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nBreakpoint ");
2844 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2845 {
2846 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
2847 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
2848 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
2849 }
2850 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
2851 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
2852 result = PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
2853 break;
2854
2855 case bp_shlib_event:
2856 /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
2857 variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
2858 to shlib event" message.) */
2859 printf_filtered (_("Stopped due to shared library event\n"));
2860 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2861 break;
2862
2863 case bp_thread_event:
2864 /* Not sure how we will get here.
2865 GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */
2866 printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
2867 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2868 break;
2869
2870 case bp_overlay_event:
2871 /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
2872 printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
2873 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2874 break;
2875
2876 case bp_longjmp_master:
2877 /* These should never be enabled. */
2878 printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
2879 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2880 break;
2881
2882 case bp_watchpoint:
2883 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
2884 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
2885 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2886 ui_out_field_string
2887 (uiout, "reason",
2888 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
2889 mention (b);
2890 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
2891 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
2892 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb->stream);
2893 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
2894 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
2895 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
2896 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
2897 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
2898 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
2899 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2900 break;
2901
2902 case bp_read_watchpoint:
2903 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2904 ui_out_field_string
2905 (uiout, "reason",
2906 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
2907 mention (b);
2908 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
2909 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
2910 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
2911 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "value", stb);
2912 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
2913 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2914 break;
2915
2916 case bp_access_watchpoint:
2917 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2918 {
2919 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
2920 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2921 ui_out_field_string
2922 (uiout, "reason",
2923 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
2924 mention (b);
2925 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
2926 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
2927 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb->stream);
2928 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
2929 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
2930 }
2931 else
2932 {
2933 mention (b);
2934 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2935 ui_out_field_string
2936 (uiout, "reason",
2937 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
2938 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
2939 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
2940 }
2941 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
2942 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
2943 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
2944 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2945 break;
2946
2947 /* Fall through, we don't deal with these types of breakpoints
2948 here. */
2949
2950 case bp_finish:
2951 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2952 ui_out_field_string
2953 (uiout, "reason",
2954 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FUNCTION_FINISHED));
2955 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2956 break;
2957
2958 case bp_until:
2959 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2960 ui_out_field_string
2961 (uiout, "reason",
2962 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED));
2963 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2964 break;
2965
2966 case bp_none:
2967 case bp_longjmp:
2968 case bp_longjmp_resume:
2969 case bp_step_resume:
2970 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
2971 case bp_call_dummy:
2972 case bp_tracepoint:
2973 case bp_jit_event:
2974 default:
2975 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2976 break;
2977 }
2978
2979 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2980 return result;
2981 }
2982
2983 /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
2984 stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
2985 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we
2986 may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
2987 normal_stop(). */
2988
2989 static enum print_stop_action
2990 print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs)
2991 {
2992 switch (bs->print_it)
2993 {
2994 case print_it_noop:
2995 /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
2996 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2997 break;
2998
2999 case print_it_done:
3000 /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
3001 relevant messages. */
3002 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
3003 break;
3004
3005 case print_it_normal:
3006 {
3007 const struct bp_location *bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3008 struct breakpoint *b = bl ? bl->owner : NULL;
3009
3010 /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method, or
3011 print_it_typical. */
3012 /* FIXME: how breakpoint can ever be NULL here? */
3013 if (b != NULL && b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_it != NULL)
3014 return b->ops->print_it (b);
3015 else
3016 return print_it_typical (bs);
3017 }
3018 break;
3019
3020 default:
3021 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
3022 _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
3023 break;
3024 }
3025 }
3026
3027 /* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from
3028 normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
3029 list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. This
3030 routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
3031 about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the
3032 "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this
3033 routine is one of:
3034
3035 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing
3036 PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
3037 code to print the location. An example is
3038 "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
3039 the location.
3040 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
3041 to also print the location part of the message.
3042 An example is the catch/throw messages, which
3043 don't require a location appended to the end.
3044 PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
3045 further info to be printed.*/
3046
3047 enum print_stop_action
3048 bpstat_print (bpstat bs)
3049 {
3050 int val;
3051
3052 /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
3053 (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
3054 That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
3055 with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */
3056 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
3057 {
3058 val = print_bp_stop_message (bs);
3059 if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY
3060 || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
3061 || val == PRINT_NOTHING)
3062 return val;
3063 }
3064
3065 /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
3066 with and nothing was printed. */
3067 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3068 }
3069
3070 /* Evaluate the expression EXP and return 1 if value is zero.
3071 This is used inside a catch_errors to evaluate the breakpoint condition.
3072 The argument is a "struct expression *" that has been cast to char * to
3073 make it pass through catch_errors. */
3074
3075 static int
3076 breakpoint_cond_eval (void *exp)
3077 {
3078 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3079 int i = !value_true (evaluate_expression ((struct expression *) exp));
3080 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3081 return i;
3082 }
3083
3084 /* Allocate a new bpstat and chain it to the current one. */
3085
3086 static bpstat
3087 bpstat_alloc (const struct bp_location *bl, bpstat cbs /* Current "bs" value */ )
3088 {
3089 bpstat bs;
3090
3091 bs = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*bs));
3092 cbs->next = bs;
3093 bs->breakpoint_at = bl;
3094 /* If the condition is false, etc., don't do the commands. */
3095 bs->commands = NULL;
3096 bs->old_val = NULL;
3097 bs->print_it = print_it_normal;
3098 return bs;
3099 }
3100 \f
3101 /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware
3102 watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */
3103
3104 int
3105 watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus *ws)
3106 {
3107 int stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
3108 CORE_ADDR addr;
3109 struct breakpoint *b;
3110
3111 if (!stopped_by_watchpoint)
3112 {
3113 /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints
3114 as not triggered. */
3115 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3116 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3117 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3118 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3119 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
3120
3121 return 0;
3122 }
3123
3124 if (!target_stopped_data_address (&current_target, &addr))
3125 {
3126 /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
3127 Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */
3128 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3129 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3130 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3131 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3132 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown;
3133
3134 return stopped_by_watchpoint;
3135 }
3136
3137 /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints
3138 affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
3139 triggered. */
3140
3141 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3142 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3143 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3144 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3145 {
3146 struct bp_location *loc;
3147 struct value *v;
3148
3149 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
3150 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3151 /* Exact match not required. Within range is
3152 sufficient. */
3153 if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range (&current_target,
3154 addr, loc->address,
3155 loc->length))
3156 {
3157 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
3158 break;
3159 }
3160 }
3161
3162 return 1;
3163 }
3164
3165 /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check (this can't be an enum
3166 because of check_errors). */
3167 /* The watchpoint has been deleted. */
3168 #define WP_DELETED 1
3169 /* The value has changed. */
3170 #define WP_VALUE_CHANGED 2
3171 /* The value has not changed. */
3172 #define WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED 3
3173
3174 #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
3175 #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
3176
3177 /* Check watchpoint condition. */
3178
3179 static int
3180 watchpoint_check (void *p)
3181 {
3182 bpstat bs = (bpstat) p;
3183 struct breakpoint *b;
3184 struct frame_info *fr;
3185 int within_current_scope;
3186
3187 b = bs->breakpoint_at->owner;
3188
3189 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
3190 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
3191 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
3192 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
3193 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
3194
3195 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
3196 within_current_scope = 1;
3197 else
3198 {
3199 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
3200 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame);
3201 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame);
3202
3203 fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
3204 within_current_scope = (fr != NULL);
3205
3206 /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
3207 returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */
3208 if (within_current_scope)
3209 {
3210 struct symbol *function;
3211
3212 function = get_frame_function (fr);
3213 if (function == NULL
3214 || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block,
3215 SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function)))
3216 within_current_scope = 0;
3217 }
3218
3219 /* in_function_epilogue_p() returns a non-zero value if we're still
3220 in the function but the stack frame has already been invalidated.
3221 Since we can't rely on the values of local variables after the
3222 stack has been destroyed, we are treating the watchpoint in that
3223 state as `not changed' without further checking. Don't mark
3224 watchpoints as changed if the current frame is in an epilogue -
3225 even if they are in some other frame, our view of the stack
3226 is likely to be wrong. */
3227 if (gdbarch_in_function_epilogue_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
3228 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
3229
3230 if (within_current_scope)
3231 /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
3232 in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect
3233 the user. */
3234 select_frame (fr);
3235 }
3236
3237 if (within_current_scope)
3238 {
3239 /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a
3240 *long* time before we return to the command level and
3241 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because
3242 we might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */
3243
3244 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3245 struct value *new_val;
3246
3247 fetch_watchpoint_value (b->exp, &new_val, NULL, NULL);
3248 if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL)
3249 || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal (b->val, new_val)))
3250 {
3251 if (new_val != NULL)
3252 {
3253 release_value (new_val);
3254 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3255 }
3256 bs->old_val = b->val;
3257 b->val = new_val;
3258 b->val_valid = 1;
3259 /* We will stop here */
3260 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
3261 }
3262 else
3263 {
3264 /* Nothing changed, don't do anything. */
3265 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3266 /* We won't stop here */
3267 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
3268 }
3269 }
3270 else
3271 {
3272 /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
3273 if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
3274 we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
3275 garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
3276 garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
3277 So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
3278 watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
3279 the first value assigned). */
3280 /* We print all the stop information in print_it_typical(), but
3281 in this case, by the time we call print_it_typical() this bp
3282 will be deleted already. So we have no choice but print the
3283 information here. */
3284 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3285 ui_out_field_string
3286 (uiout, "reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE));
3287 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nWatchpoint ");
3288 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "wpnum", b->number);
3289 ui_out_text (uiout, " deleted because the program has left the block in\n\
3290 which its expression is valid.\n");
3291
3292 if (b->related_breakpoint)
3293 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3294 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3295
3296 return WP_DELETED;
3297 }
3298 }
3299
3300 /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
3301 breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we
3302 should stop, only if BL explains the stop. */
3303 static int
3304 bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl,
3305 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr)
3306 {
3307 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3308
3309 if (b->type != bp_watchpoint
3310 && b->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
3311 && b->type != bp_read_watchpoint
3312 && b->type != bp_access_watchpoint
3313 && b->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint
3314 && b->type != bp_catchpoint) /* a non-watchpoint bp */
3315 {
3316 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
3317 aspace, bp_addr))
3318 return 0;
3319 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
3320 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3321 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3322 return 0;
3323 }
3324
3325 /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
3326 reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
3327 some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
3328 in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
3329 been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
3330 (did not match the data address). */
3331
3332 if ((b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3333 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3334 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3335 && b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no)
3336 return 0;
3337
3338 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
3339 {
3340 if (bl->address != bp_addr)
3341 return 0;
3342 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
3343 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3344 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3345 return 0;
3346 }
3347
3348 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
3349 {
3350 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->breakpoint_hit != NULL);
3351 if (!b->ops->breakpoint_hit (b))
3352 return 0;
3353 }
3354
3355 return 1;
3356 }
3357
3358 /* If BS refers to a watchpoint, determine if the watched values
3359 has actually changed, and we should stop. If not, set BS->stop
3360 to 0. */
3361 static void
3362 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
3363 {
3364 const struct bp_location *bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3365 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3366
3367 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint
3368 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3369 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint
3370 || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
3371 {
3372 CORE_ADDR addr;
3373 struct value *v;
3374 int must_check_value = 0;
3375
3376 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint)
3377 /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
3378 watched value. */
3379 must_check_value = 1;
3380 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes)
3381 /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
3382 and the target earlier reported an address watched by
3383 this watchpoint. */
3384 must_check_value = 1;
3385 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown
3386 && b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
3387 /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
3388 not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's
3389 value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
3390 a data address, we can't figure it out. */
3391 must_check_value = 1;
3392
3393 if (must_check_value)
3394 {
3395 char *message = xstrprintf ("Error evaluating expression for watchpoint %d\n",
3396 b->number);
3397 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
3398 int e = catch_errors (watchpoint_check, bs, message,
3399 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
3400 do_cleanups (cleanups);
3401 switch (e)
3402 {
3403 case WP_DELETED:
3404 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
3405 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
3406 /* Stop. */
3407 break;
3408 case WP_VALUE_CHANGED:
3409 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
3410 {
3411 /* Don't stop: read watchpoints shouldn't fire if
3412 the value has changed. This is for targets
3413 which cannot set read-only watchpoints. */
3414 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3415 bs->stop = 0;
3416 }
3417 break;
3418 case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED:
3419 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3420 || b->type == bp_watchpoint)
3421 {
3422 /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
3423 the value hasn't changed. */
3424 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3425 bs->stop = 0;
3426 }
3427 /* Stop. */
3428 break;
3429 default:
3430 /* Can't happen. */
3431 case 0:
3432 /* Error from catch_errors. */
3433 printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"), b->number);
3434 if (b->related_breakpoint)
3435 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3436 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3437 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
3438 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
3439 break;
3440 }
3441 }
3442 else /* must_check_value == 0 */
3443 {
3444 /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
3445 not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
3446 watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print
3447 anything for this watchpoint. */
3448 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3449 bs->stop = 0;
3450 }
3451 }
3452 }
3453
3454
3455 /* Check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
3456 of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this
3457 breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */
3458 static void
3459 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs, ptid_t ptid)
3460 {
3461 int thread_id = pid_to_thread_id (ptid);
3462 const struct bp_location *bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3463 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3464
3465 if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id)
3466 && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
3467 bs->stop = 0;
3468 else if (bs->stop)
3469 {
3470 int value_is_zero = 0;
3471
3472 /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
3473 watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
3474 out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next
3475 iteration. */
3476 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
3477 b->related_breakpoint->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
3478
3479 if (bl->cond && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
3480 {
3481 /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
3482 be a long time before we return to the command level and
3483 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values
3484 because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
3485 function call. */
3486 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3487
3488 /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
3489 the conditions will have the right context. Because we
3490 use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
3491 variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
3492 of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
3493 call site. */
3494 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
3495 value_is_zero
3496 = catch_errors (breakpoint_cond_eval, (bl->cond),
3497 "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n",
3498 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
3499 /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint # */
3500 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3501 }
3502 if (bl->cond && value_is_zero)
3503 {
3504 bs->stop = 0;
3505 }
3506 else if (b->thread != -1 && b->thread != thread_id)
3507 {
3508 bs->stop = 0;
3509 }
3510 else if (b->ignore_count > 0)
3511 {
3512 b->ignore_count--;
3513 annotate_ignore_count_change ();
3514 bs->stop = 0;
3515 /* Increase the hit count even though we don't
3516 stop. */
3517 ++(b->hit_count);
3518 }
3519 }
3520 }
3521
3522
3523 /* Get a bpstat associated with having just stopped at address
3524 BP_ADDR in thread PTID.
3525
3526 Determine whether we stopped at a breakpoint, etc, or whether we
3527 don't understand this stop. Result is a chain of bpstat's such that:
3528
3529 if we don't understand the stop, the result is a null pointer.
3530
3531 if we understand why we stopped, the result is not null.
3532
3533 Each element of the chain refers to a particular breakpoint or
3534 watchpoint at which we have stopped. (We may have stopped for
3535 several reasons concurrently.)
3536
3537 Each element of the chain has valid next, breakpoint_at,
3538 commands, FIXME??? fields. */
3539
3540 bpstat
3541 bpstat_stop_status (struct address_space *aspace,
3542 CORE_ADDR bp_addr, ptid_t ptid)
3543 {
3544 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
3545 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3546 struct bp_location *loc;
3547 /* Root of the chain of bpstat's */
3548 struct bpstats root_bs[1];
3549 /* Pointer to the last thing in the chain currently. */
3550 bpstat bs = root_bs;
3551 int ix;
3552 int need_remove_insert, update_locations = 0;
3553
3554 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3555 {
3556 b = bl->owner;
3557 gdb_assert (b);
3558 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
3559 continue;
3560
3561 /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first location.
3562 The watchpoint_check function will work on entire expression,
3563 not the individual locations. For read watchopints, the
3564 watchpoints_triggered function have checked all locations
3565 already. */
3566 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc)
3567 continue;
3568
3569 if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr))
3570 continue;
3571
3572 /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address matches */
3573
3574 bs = bpstat_alloc (bl, bs); /* Alloc a bpstat to explain stop */
3575
3576 /* Assume we stop. Should we find watchpoint that is not actually
3577 triggered, or if condition of breakpoint is false, we'll reset
3578 'stop' to 0. */
3579 bs->stop = 1;
3580 bs->print = 1;
3581
3582 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs);
3583 if (!bs->stop)
3584 continue;
3585
3586 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
3587 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
3588 /* We do not stop for these. */
3589 bs->stop = 0;
3590 else
3591 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, ptid);
3592
3593 if (bs->stop)
3594 {
3595 if (b->enable_state != bp_disabled)
3596 ++(b->hit_count);
3597
3598 /* We will stop here */
3599 if (b->disposition == disp_disable)
3600 {
3601 if (b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
3602 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3603 update_locations = 1;
3604 }
3605 if (b->silent)
3606 bs->print = 0;
3607 bs->commands = b->commands;
3608 if (bs->commands
3609 && (strcmp ("silent", bs->commands->line) == 0
3610 || (xdb_commands && strcmp ("Q", bs->commands->line) == 0)))
3611 {
3612 bs->commands = bs->commands->next;
3613 bs->print = 0;
3614 }
3615 bs->commands = copy_command_lines (bs->commands);
3616 }
3617
3618 /* Print nothing for this entry if we dont stop or if we dont print. */
3619 if (bs->stop == 0 || bs->print == 0)
3620 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3621 }
3622
3623 /* Delay this call which would break the ALL_BP_LOCATIONS iteration above. */
3624 if (update_locations)
3625 update_global_location_list (0);
3626
3627 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
3628 {
3629 if (breakpoint_address_match (loc->pspace->aspace, loc->address,
3630 aspace, bp_addr))
3631 {
3632 bs = bpstat_alloc (loc, bs);
3633 /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */
3634 bs->stop = 0;
3635 bs->print = 0;
3636 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3637 }
3638 }
3639
3640 bs->next = NULL; /* Terminate the chain */
3641 bs = root_bs->next; /* Re-grab the head of the chain */
3642
3643 /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
3644 not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
3645 watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
3646 done later. */
3647 for (bs = root_bs->next; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3648 if (bs->stop)
3649 break;
3650
3651 need_remove_insert = 0;
3652 if (bs == NULL)
3653 for (bs = root_bs->next; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3654 if (!bs->stop
3655 && bs->breakpoint_at->owner
3656 && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner))
3657 {
3658 update_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
3659 /* Updating watchpoints invalidates bs->breakpoint_at.
3660 Prevent further code from trying to use it. */
3661 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
3662 need_remove_insert = 1;
3663 }
3664
3665 if (need_remove_insert)
3666 update_global_location_list (1);
3667
3668 return root_bs->next;
3669 }
3670 \f
3671 /* Tell what to do about this bpstat. */
3672 struct bpstat_what
3673 bpstat_what (bpstat bs)
3674 {
3675 /* Classify each bpstat as one of the following. */
3676 enum class
3677 {
3678 /* This bpstat element has no effect on the main_action. */
3679 no_effect = 0,
3680
3681 /* There was a watchpoint, stop but don't print. */
3682 wp_silent,
3683
3684 /* There was a watchpoint, stop and print. */
3685 wp_noisy,
3686
3687 /* There was a breakpoint but we're not stopping. */
3688 bp_nostop,
3689
3690 /* There was a breakpoint, stop but don't print. */
3691 bp_silent,
3692
3693 /* There was a breakpoint, stop and print. */
3694 bp_noisy,
3695
3696 /* We hit the longjmp breakpoint. */
3697 long_jump,
3698
3699 /* We hit the longjmp_resume breakpoint. */
3700 long_resume,
3701
3702 /* We hit the step_resume breakpoint. */
3703 step_resume,
3704
3705 /* We hit the shared library event breakpoint. */
3706 shlib_event,
3707
3708 /* We hit the jit event breakpoint. */
3709 jit_event,
3710
3711 /* This is just used to count how many enums there are. */
3712 class_last
3713 };
3714
3715 /* Here is the table which drives this routine. So that we can
3716 format it pretty, we define some abbreviations for the
3717 enum bpstat_what codes. */
3718 #define kc BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING
3719 #define ss BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT
3720 #define sn BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY
3721 #define sgl BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE
3722 #define slr BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME
3723 #define clr BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME
3724 #define sr BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME
3725 #define shl BPSTAT_WHAT_CHECK_SHLIBS
3726 #define jit BPSTAT_WHAT_CHECK_JIT
3727
3728 /* "Can't happen." Might want to print an error message.
3729 abort() is not out of the question, but chances are GDB is just
3730 a bit confused, not unusable. */
3731 #define err BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY
3732
3733 /* Given an old action and a class, come up with a new action. */
3734 /* One interesting property of this table is that wp_silent is the same
3735 as bp_silent and wp_noisy is the same as bp_noisy. That is because
3736 after stopping, the check for whether to step over a breakpoint
3737 (BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE type stuff) is handled in proceed() without
3738 reference to how we stopped. We retain separate wp_silent and
3739 bp_silent codes in case we want to change that someday.
3740
3741 Another possibly interesting property of this table is that
3742 there's a partial ordering, priority-like, of the actions. Once
3743 you've decided that some action is appropriate, you'll never go
3744 back and decide something of a lower priority is better. The
3745 ordering is:
3746
3747 kc < jit clr sgl shl slr sn sr ss
3748 sgl < jit shl slr sn sr ss
3749 slr < jit err shl sn sr ss
3750 clr < jit err shl sn sr ss
3751 ss < jit shl sn sr
3752 sn < jit shl sr
3753 jit < shl sr
3754 shl < sr
3755 sr <
3756
3757 What I think this means is that we don't need a damned table
3758 here. If you just put the rows and columns in the right order,
3759 it'd look awfully regular. We could simply walk the bpstat list
3760 and choose the highest priority action we find, with a little
3761 logic to handle the 'err' cases. */
3762
3763 /* step_resume entries: a step resume breakpoint overrides another
3764 breakpoint of signal handling (see comment in wait_for_inferior
3765 at where we set the step_resume breakpoint). */
3766
3767 static const enum bpstat_what_main_action
3768 table[(int) class_last][(int) BPSTAT_WHAT_LAST] =
3769 {
3770 /* old action */
3771 /* kc ss sn sgl slr clr sr shl jit */
3772 /* no_effect */ {kc, ss, sn, sgl, slr, clr, sr, shl, jit},
3773 /* wp_silent */ {ss, ss, sn, ss, ss, ss, sr, shl, jit},
3774 /* wp_noisy */ {sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sr, shl, jit},
3775 /* bp_nostop */ {sgl, ss, sn, sgl, slr, slr, sr, shl, jit},
3776 /* bp_silent */ {ss, ss, sn, ss, ss, ss, sr, shl, jit},
3777 /* bp_noisy */ {sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sr, shl, jit},
3778 /* long_jump */ {slr, ss, sn, slr, slr, err, sr, shl, jit},
3779 /* long_resume */ {clr, ss, sn, err, err, err, sr, shl, jit},
3780 /* step_resume */ {sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr },
3781 /* shlib */ {shl, shl, shl, shl, shl, shl, sr, shl, shl},
3782 /* jit_event */ {jit, jit, jit, jit, jit, jit, sr, jit, jit}
3783 };
3784
3785 #undef kc
3786 #undef ss
3787 #undef sn
3788 #undef sgl
3789 #undef slr
3790 #undef clr
3791 #undef err
3792 #undef sr
3793 #undef ts
3794 #undef shl
3795 #undef jit
3796 enum bpstat_what_main_action current_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
3797 struct bpstat_what retval;
3798
3799 retval.call_dummy = 0;
3800 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3801 {
3802 enum class bs_class = no_effect;
3803 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
3804 /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary breakpoint
3805 which has since been deleted. */
3806 continue;
3807 if (bs->breakpoint_at->owner == NULL)
3808 bs_class = bp_nostop;
3809 else
3810 switch (bs->breakpoint_at->owner->type)
3811 {
3812 case bp_none:
3813 continue;
3814
3815 case bp_breakpoint:
3816 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
3817 case bp_until:
3818 case bp_finish:
3819 if (bs->stop)
3820 {
3821 if (bs->print)
3822 bs_class = bp_noisy;
3823 else
3824 bs_class = bp_silent;
3825 }
3826 else
3827 bs_class = bp_nostop;
3828 break;
3829 case bp_watchpoint:
3830 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
3831 case bp_read_watchpoint:
3832 case bp_access_watchpoint:
3833 if (bs->stop)
3834 {
3835 if (bs->print)
3836 bs_class = wp_noisy;
3837 else
3838 bs_class = wp_silent;
3839 }
3840 else
3841 /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
3842 This requires no further action. */
3843 bs_class = no_effect;
3844 break;
3845 case bp_longjmp:
3846 bs_class = long_jump;
3847 break;
3848 case bp_longjmp_resume:
3849 bs_class = long_resume;
3850 break;
3851 case bp_step_resume:
3852 if (bs->stop)
3853 {
3854 bs_class = step_resume;
3855 }
3856 else
3857 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
3858 bs_class = bp_nostop;
3859 break;
3860 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
3861 bs_class = bp_nostop;
3862 break;
3863 case bp_shlib_event:
3864 bs_class = shlib_event;
3865 break;
3866 case bp_jit_event:
3867 bs_class = jit_event;
3868 break;
3869 case bp_thread_event:
3870 case bp_overlay_event:
3871 case bp_longjmp_master:
3872 bs_class = bp_nostop;
3873 break;
3874 case bp_catchpoint:
3875 if (bs->stop)
3876 {
3877 if (bs->print)
3878 bs_class = bp_noisy;
3879 else
3880 bs_class = bp_silent;
3881 }
3882 else
3883 /* There was a catchpoint, but we're not stopping.
3884 This requires no further action. */
3885 bs_class = no_effect;
3886 break;
3887 case bp_call_dummy:
3888 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
3889 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
3890 bs_class = bp_silent;
3891 retval.call_dummy = 1;
3892 break;
3893 case bp_tracepoint:
3894 /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
3895 if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
3896 out already. */
3897 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
3898 _("bpstat_what: bp_tracepoint encountered"));
3899 break;
3900 }
3901 current_action = table[(int) bs_class][(int) current_action];
3902 }
3903 retval.main_action = current_action;
3904 return retval;
3905 }
3906
3907 /* Nonzero if we should step constantly (e.g. watchpoints on machines
3908 without hardware support). This isn't related to a specific bpstat,
3909 just to things like whether watchpoints are set. */
3910
3911 int
3912 bpstat_should_step (void)
3913 {
3914 struct breakpoint *b;
3915 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3916 if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL)
3917 return 1;
3918 return 0;
3919 }
3920
3921 int
3922 bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs)
3923 {
3924 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3925 if (bs->stop)
3926 return 1;
3927
3928 return 0;
3929 }
3930
3931 \f
3932
3933 static void print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
3934 struct bp_location *loc,
3935 char *wrap_indent,
3936 struct ui_stream *stb)
3937 {
3938 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
3939
3940 if (loc != NULL)
3941 set_current_program_space (loc->pspace);
3942
3943 if (b->source_file)
3944 {
3945 struct symbol *sym
3946 = find_pc_sect_function (loc->address, loc->section);
3947 if (sym)
3948 {
3949 ui_out_text (uiout, "in ");
3950 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "func",
3951 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
3952 ui_out_wrap_hint (uiout, wrap_indent);
3953 ui_out_text (uiout, " at ");
3954 }
3955 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "file", b->source_file);
3956 ui_out_text (uiout, ":");
3957
3958 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3959 {
3960 struct symtab_and_line sal = find_pc_line (loc->address, 0);
3961 char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab);
3962
3963 if (fullname)
3964 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "fullname", fullname);
3965 }
3966
3967 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "line", b->line_number);
3968 }
3969 else if (!b->loc)
3970 {
3971 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "pending", b->addr_string);
3972 }
3973 else
3974 {
3975 print_address_symbolic (loc->address, stb->stream, demangle, "");
3976 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "at", stb);
3977 }
3978
3979 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3980 }
3981
3982 /* Print B to gdb_stdout. */
3983 static void
3984 print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
3985 struct bp_location *loc,
3986 int loc_number,
3987 struct bp_location **last_loc,
3988 int print_address_bits,
3989 int allflag)
3990 {
3991 struct command_line *l;
3992 struct symbol *sym;
3993 struct ep_type_description
3994 {
3995 enum bptype type;
3996 char *description;
3997 };
3998 static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] =
3999 {
4000 {bp_none, "?deleted?"},
4001 {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"},
4002 {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"},
4003 {bp_until, "until"},
4004 {bp_finish, "finish"},
4005 {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"},
4006 {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"},
4007 {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"},
4008 {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"},
4009 {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"},
4010 {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"},
4011 {bp_step_resume, "step resume"},
4012 {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"},
4013 {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"},
4014 {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"},
4015 {bp_thread_event, "thread events"},
4016 {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"},
4017 {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"},
4018 {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"},
4019 {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"},
4020 {bp_jit_event, "jit events"},
4021 };
4022
4023 static char bpenables[] = "nynny";
4024 char wrap_indent[80];
4025 struct ui_stream *stb = ui_out_stream_new (uiout);
4026 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_stream_delete (stb);
4027 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain;
4028
4029 int header_of_multiple = 0;
4030 int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL);
4031 struct value_print_options opts;
4032
4033 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4034
4035 gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0);
4036 /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning
4037 treatment of breakpoints with single disabled
4038 location. */
4039 if (loc == NULL
4040 && (b->loc != NULL
4041 && (b->loc->next != NULL || !b->loc->enabled)))
4042 header_of_multiple = 1;
4043 if (loc == NULL)
4044 loc = b->loc;
4045
4046 annotate_record ();
4047 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "bkpt");
4048
4049 /* 1 */
4050 annotate_field (0);
4051 if (part_of_multiple)
4052 {
4053 char *formatted;
4054 formatted = xstrprintf ("%d.%d", b->number, loc_number);
4055 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "number", formatted);
4056 xfree (formatted);
4057 }
4058 else
4059 {
4060 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
4061 }
4062
4063 /* 2 */
4064 annotate_field (1);
4065 if (part_of_multiple)
4066 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "type");
4067 else
4068 {
4069 if (((int) b->type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0])))
4070 || ((int) b->type != bptypes[(int) b->type].type))
4071 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4072 _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
4073 (int) b->type);
4074 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "type", bptypes[(int) b->type].description);
4075 }
4076
4077 /* 3 */
4078 annotate_field (2);
4079 if (part_of_multiple)
4080 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "disp");
4081 else
4082 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
4083
4084
4085 /* 4 */
4086 annotate_field (3);
4087 if (part_of_multiple)
4088 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "enabled", loc->enabled ? "y" : "n");
4089 else
4090 ui_out_field_fmt (uiout, "enabled", "%c",
4091 bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]);
4092 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 2);
4093
4094
4095 /* 5 and 6 */
4096 strcpy (wrap_indent, " ");
4097 if (opts.addressprint)
4098 {
4099 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
4100 strcat (wrap_indent, " ");
4101 else
4102 strcat (wrap_indent, " ");
4103 }
4104
4105 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL)
4106 {
4107 /* Although the print_one can possibly print
4108 all locations, calling it here is not likely
4109 to get any nice result. So, make sure there's
4110 just one location. */
4111 gdb_assert (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->next == NULL);
4112 b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc);
4113 }
4114 else
4115 switch (b->type)
4116 {
4117 case bp_none:
4118 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4119 _("print_one_breakpoint: bp_none encountered\n"));
4120 break;
4121
4122 case bp_watchpoint:
4123 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4124 case bp_read_watchpoint:
4125 case bp_access_watchpoint:
4126 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
4127 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
4128 is relatively readable). */
4129 if (opts.addressprint)
4130 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
4131 annotate_field (5);
4132 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", b->exp_string);
4133 break;
4134
4135 case bp_breakpoint:
4136 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
4137 case bp_until:
4138 case bp_finish:
4139 case bp_longjmp:
4140 case bp_longjmp_resume:
4141 case bp_step_resume:
4142 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4143 case bp_call_dummy:
4144 case bp_shlib_event:
4145 case bp_thread_event:
4146 case bp_overlay_event:
4147 case bp_longjmp_master:
4148 case bp_tracepoint:
4149 case bp_jit_event:
4150 if (opts.addressprint)
4151 {
4152 annotate_field (4);
4153 if (header_of_multiple)
4154 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<MULTIPLE>");
4155 else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled)
4156 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
4157 else
4158 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
4159 loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
4160 }
4161 annotate_field (5);
4162 if (!header_of_multiple)
4163 print_breakpoint_location (b, loc, wrap_indent, stb);
4164 if (b->loc)
4165 *last_loc = b->loc;
4166 break;
4167 }
4168
4169
4170 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors unless there
4171 are several. */
4172 if (loc != NULL
4173 && !header_of_multiple
4174 && (allflag
4175 || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
4176 && (number_of_program_spaces () > 1
4177 || number_of_inferiors () > 1)
4178 && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint)))
4179 {
4180 struct inferior *inf;
4181 int first = 1;
4182
4183 for (inf = inferior_list; inf != NULL; inf = inf->next)
4184 {
4185 if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace)
4186 {
4187 if (first)
4188 {
4189 first = 0;
4190 ui_out_text (uiout, " inf ");
4191 }
4192 else
4193 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
4194 ui_out_text (uiout, plongest (inf->num));
4195 }
4196 }
4197 }
4198
4199 if (!part_of_multiple)
4200 {
4201 if (b->thread != -1)
4202 {
4203 /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
4204 "stop only in" line a little further down. */
4205 ui_out_text (uiout, " thread ");
4206 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
4207 }
4208 else if (b->task != 0)
4209 {
4210 ui_out_text (uiout, " task ");
4211 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "task", b->task);
4212 }
4213 }
4214
4215 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4216
4217 if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id))
4218 {
4219 annotate_field (6);
4220 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in stack frame at ");
4221 /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poeking around inside
4222 the frame ID. */
4223 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "frame",
4224 b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr);
4225 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4226 }
4227
4228 if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string && !ada_exception_catchpoint_p (b))
4229 {
4230 /* We do not print the condition for Ada exception catchpoints
4231 because the condition is an internal implementation detail
4232 that we do not want to expose to the user. */
4233 annotate_field (7);
4234 if (b->type == bp_tracepoint)
4235 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttrace only if ");
4236 else
4237 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only if ");
4238 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "cond", b->cond_string);
4239 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4240 }
4241
4242 if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1)
4243 {
4244 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this */
4245 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in thread ");
4246 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
4247 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4248 }
4249
4250 if (!part_of_multiple && b->hit_count)
4251 {
4252 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this */
4253 if (ep_is_catchpoint (b))
4254 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tcatchpoint");
4255 else
4256 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tbreakpoint");
4257 ui_out_text (uiout, " already hit ");
4258 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
4259 if (b->hit_count == 1)
4260 ui_out_text (uiout, " time\n");
4261 else
4262 ui_out_text (uiout, " times\n");
4263 }
4264
4265 /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is
4266 mi. FIXME: Should have a better test for this. */
4267 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4268 if (!part_of_multiple && b->hit_count == 0)
4269 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
4270
4271 if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count)
4272 {
4273 annotate_field (8);
4274 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tignore next ");
4275 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "ignore", b->ignore_count);
4276 ui_out_text (uiout, " hits\n");
4277 }
4278
4279 l = b->commands;
4280 if (!part_of_multiple && l)
4281 {
4282 struct cleanup *script_chain;
4283
4284 annotate_field (9);
4285 script_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "script");
4286 print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4);
4287 do_cleanups (script_chain);
4288 }
4289
4290 if (!part_of_multiple && b->pass_count)
4291 {
4292 annotate_field (10);
4293 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tpass count ");
4294 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "pass", b->pass_count);
4295 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
4296 }
4297
4298 if (!part_of_multiple && b->step_count)
4299 {
4300 annotate_field (11);
4301 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstep count ");
4302 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "step", b->step_count);
4303 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
4304 }
4305
4306 if (!part_of_multiple && b->actions)
4307 {
4308 struct action_line *action;
4309 annotate_field (12);
4310 for (action = b->actions; action; action = action->next)
4311 {
4312 ui_out_text (uiout, " A\t");
4313 ui_out_text (uiout, action->action);
4314 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4315 }
4316 }
4317
4318 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout) && !part_of_multiple)
4319 {
4320 if (b->addr_string)
4321 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", b->addr_string);
4322 else if (b->exp_string)
4323 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", b->exp_string);
4324 }
4325
4326 do_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
4327 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4328 }
4329
4330 static void
4331 print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
4332 struct bp_location **last_loc, int print_address_bits,
4333 int allflag)
4334 {
4335 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc,
4336 print_address_bits, allflag);
4337
4338 /* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
4339 it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual
4340 locations, if any. */
4341 if (b->ops == NULL || b->ops->print_one == NULL)
4342 {
4343 /* If breakpoint has a single location that is
4344 disabled, we print it as if it had
4345 several locations, since otherwise it's hard to
4346 represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
4347 situation.
4348 Note that while hardware watchpoints have
4349 several locations internally, that's no a property
4350 exposed to user. */
4351 if (b->loc
4352 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
4353 && (b->loc->next || !b->loc->enabled)
4354 && !ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4355 {
4356 struct bp_location *loc;
4357 int n = 1;
4358 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next, ++n)
4359 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc,
4360 print_address_bits, allflag);
4361 }
4362 }
4363 }
4364
4365 static int
4366 breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b)
4367 {
4368 int print_address_bits = 0;
4369 struct bp_location *loc;
4370
4371 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4372 {
4373 int addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch);
4374 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
4375 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
4376 }
4377
4378 return print_address_bits;
4379 }
4380
4381 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args
4382 {
4383 int bnum;
4384 };
4385
4386 static int
4387 do_captured_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, void *data)
4388 {
4389 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args *args = data;
4390 struct breakpoint *b;
4391 struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL;
4392 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4393 {
4394 if (args->bnum == b->number)
4395 {
4396 int print_address_bits = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
4397 print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, print_address_bits, 0);
4398 return GDB_RC_OK;
4399 }
4400 }
4401 return GDB_RC_NONE;
4402 }
4403
4404 enum gdb_rc
4405 gdb_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, int bnum, char **error_message)
4406 {
4407 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args args;
4408 args.bnum = bnum;
4409 /* For the moment we don't trust print_one_breakpoint() to not throw
4410 an error. */
4411 if (catch_exceptions_with_msg (uiout, do_captured_breakpoint_query, &args,
4412 error_message, RETURN_MASK_ALL) < 0)
4413 return GDB_RC_FAIL;
4414 else
4415 return GDB_RC_OK;
4416 }
4417
4418 /* Return non-zero if B is user settable (breakpoints, watchpoints,
4419 catchpoints, et.al.). */
4420
4421 static int
4422 user_settable_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
4423 {
4424 return (b->type == bp_breakpoint
4425 || b->type == bp_catchpoint
4426 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
4427 || b->type == bp_tracepoint
4428 || b->type == bp_watchpoint
4429 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
4430 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint
4431 || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint);
4432 }
4433
4434 /* Print information on user settable breakpoint (watchpoint, etc)
4435 number BNUM. If BNUM is -1 print all user settable breakpoints.
4436 If ALLFLAG is non-zero, include non- user settable breakpoints. */
4437
4438 static void
4439 breakpoint_1 (int bnum, int allflag)
4440 {
4441 struct breakpoint *b;
4442 struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL;
4443 int nr_printable_breakpoints;
4444 struct cleanup *bkpttbl_chain;
4445 struct value_print_options opts;
4446 int print_address_bits = 0;
4447
4448 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4449
4450 /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the
4451 size required for address fields. */
4452 nr_printable_breakpoints = 0;
4453 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4454 if (bnum == -1
4455 || bnum == b->number)
4456 {
4457 if (allflag || user_settable_breakpoint (b))
4458 {
4459 int addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
4460 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
4461 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
4462
4463 nr_printable_breakpoints++;
4464 }
4465 }
4466
4467 if (opts.addressprint)
4468 bkpttbl_chain
4469 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 6, nr_printable_breakpoints,
4470 "BreakpointTable");
4471 else
4472 bkpttbl_chain
4473 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 5, nr_printable_breakpoints,
4474 "BreakpointTable");
4475
4476 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4477 annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
4478 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4479 annotate_field (0);
4480 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */
4481 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4482 annotate_field (1);
4483 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 14, ui_left, "type", "Type"); /* 2 */
4484 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4485 annotate_field (2);
4486 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */
4487 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4488 annotate_field (3);
4489 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */
4490 if (opts.addressprint)
4491 {
4492 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4493 annotate_field (4);
4494 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
4495 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 10, ui_left, "addr", "Address");/* 5 */
4496 else
4497 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 18, ui_left, "addr", "Address");/* 5 */
4498 }
4499 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4500 annotate_field (5);
4501 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */
4502 ui_out_table_body (uiout);
4503 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4504 annotate_breakpoints_table ();
4505
4506 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4507 if (bnum == -1
4508 || bnum == b->number)
4509 {
4510 /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
4511 allflag is set. */
4512 if (allflag || user_settable_breakpoint (b))
4513 print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, print_address_bits, allflag);
4514 }
4515
4516 do_cleanups (bkpttbl_chain);
4517
4518 if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0)
4519 {
4520 if (bnum == -1)
4521 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
4522 else
4523 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No breakpoint or watchpoint number %d.\n",
4524 bnum);
4525 }
4526 else
4527 {
4528 if (last_loc && !server_command)
4529 set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address);
4530 }
4531
4532 /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
4533 there have been breakpoints? */
4534 annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
4535 }
4536
4537 static void
4538 breakpoints_info (char *bnum_exp, int from_tty)
4539 {
4540 int bnum = -1;
4541
4542 if (bnum_exp)
4543 bnum = parse_and_eval_long (bnum_exp);
4544
4545 breakpoint_1 (bnum, 0);
4546 }
4547
4548 static void
4549 maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *bnum_exp, int from_tty)
4550 {
4551 int bnum = -1;
4552
4553 if (bnum_exp)
4554 bnum = parse_and_eval_long (bnum_exp);
4555
4556 breakpoint_1 (bnum, 1);
4557 }
4558
4559 static int
4560 breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b,
4561 struct program_space *pspace,
4562 CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section)
4563 {
4564 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
4565 for (; bl; bl = bl->next)
4566 {
4567 if (bl->pspace == pspace
4568 && bl->address == pc
4569 && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section))
4570 return 1;
4571 }
4572 return 0;
4573 }
4574
4575 /* Print a message describing any breakpoints set at PC. This
4576 concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
4577 address spaces. */
4578
4579 static void
4580 describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
4581 struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
4582 struct obj_section *section, int thread)
4583 {
4584 int others = 0;
4585 struct breakpoint *b;
4586
4587 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4588 others += breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section);
4589 if (others > 0)
4590 {
4591 if (others == 1)
4592 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint "));
4593 else /* if (others == ???) */
4594 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints "));
4595 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4596 if (breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section))
4597 {
4598 others--;
4599 printf_filtered ("%d", b->number);
4600 if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1)
4601 printf_filtered (" (all threads)");
4602 else if (b->thread != -1)
4603 printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b->thread);
4604 printf_filtered ("%s%s ",
4605 ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled
4606 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled
4607 || b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
4608 ? " (disabled)"
4609 : b->enable_state == bp_permanent
4610 ? " (permanent)"
4611 : ""),
4612 (others > 1) ? ","
4613 : ((others == 1) ? " and" : ""));
4614 }
4615 printf_filtered (_("also set at pc "));
4616 fputs_filtered (paddress (gdbarch, pc), gdb_stdout);
4617 printf_filtered (".\n");
4618 }
4619 }
4620 \f
4621 /* Set the default place to put a breakpoint
4622 for the `break' command with no arguments. */
4623
4624 void
4625 set_default_breakpoint (int valid, struct program_space *pspace,
4626 CORE_ADDR addr, struct symtab *symtab,
4627 int line)
4628 {
4629 default_breakpoint_valid = valid;
4630 default_breakpoint_pspace = pspace;
4631 default_breakpoint_address = addr;
4632 default_breakpoint_symtab = symtab;
4633 default_breakpoint_line = line;
4634 }
4635
4636 /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of
4637 BPT. For some breakpoint types, the address member is irrelevant
4638 and it makes no sense to attempt to compare it to other addresses
4639 (or use it for any other purpose either).
4640
4641 More specifically, each of the following breakpoint types will always
4642 have a zero valued address and we don't want to mark breakpoints of any of
4643 these types to be a duplicate of an actual breakpoint at address zero:
4644
4645 bp_watchpoint
4646 bp_catchpoint
4647
4648 */
4649
4650 static int
4651 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (struct breakpoint *bpt)
4652 {
4653 enum bptype type = bpt->type;
4654
4655 return (type != bp_watchpoint && type != bp_catchpoint);
4656 }
4657
4658 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
4659 true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */
4660
4661 static int
4662 watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1, struct bp_location *loc2)
4663 {
4664 return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type
4665 && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace
4666 && loc1->address == loc2->address
4667 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
4668 }
4669
4670 /* Returns true if {ASPACE1,ADDR1} and {ASPACE2,ADDR2} represent the
4671 same breakpoint location. In most targets, this can only be true
4672 if ASPACE1 matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global
4673 breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
4674
4675 static int
4676 breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
4677 struct address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2)
4678 {
4679 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
4680 || aspace1 == aspace2)
4681 && addr1 == addr2);
4682 }
4683
4684 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
4685 (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2
4686 represent the same location. */
4687
4688 static int
4689 breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1, struct bp_location *loc2)
4690 {
4691 int hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner);
4692 int hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner);
4693
4694 if (hw_point1 != hw_point2)
4695 return 0;
4696 else if (hw_point1)
4697 return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
4698 else
4699 return breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address,
4700 loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address);
4701 }
4702
4703 static void
4704 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr,
4705 int bnum, int have_bnum)
4706 {
4707 char astr1[40];
4708 char astr2[40];
4709
4710 strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8));
4711 strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8));
4712 if (have_bnum)
4713 warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
4714 bnum, astr1, astr2);
4715 else
4716 warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2);
4717 }
4718
4719 /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural constraints
4720 on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address. Note: Very
4721 few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most targets,
4722 this function is simply the identity function. */
4723
4724 static CORE_ADDR
4725 adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
4726 CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype)
4727 {
4728 if (!gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch))
4729 {
4730 /* Very few targets need any kind of breakpoint adjustment. */
4731 return bpaddr;
4732 }
4733 else if (bptype == bp_watchpoint
4734 || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint
4735 || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint
4736 || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint
4737 || bptype == bp_catchpoint)
4738 {
4739 /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
4740 have their addresses modified. */
4741 return bpaddr;
4742 }
4743 else
4744 {
4745 CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr;
4746
4747 /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
4748 of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */
4749 adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr);
4750
4751 /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
4752 a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment
4753 is required. */
4754 if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr)
4755 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0);
4756
4757 return adjusted_bpaddr;
4758 }
4759 }
4760
4761 /* Allocate a struct bp_location. */
4762
4763 static struct bp_location *
4764 allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt)
4765 {
4766 struct bp_location *loc, *loc_p;
4767
4768 loc = xmalloc (sizeof (struct bp_location));
4769 memset (loc, 0, sizeof (*loc));
4770
4771 loc->owner = bpt;
4772 loc->cond = NULL;
4773 loc->shlib_disabled = 0;
4774 loc->enabled = 1;
4775
4776 switch (bpt->type)
4777 {
4778 case bp_breakpoint:
4779 case bp_tracepoint:
4780 case bp_until:
4781 case bp_finish:
4782 case bp_longjmp:
4783 case bp_longjmp_resume:
4784 case bp_step_resume:
4785 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4786 case bp_call_dummy:
4787 case bp_shlib_event:
4788 case bp_thread_event:
4789 case bp_overlay_event:
4790 case bp_jit_event:
4791 case bp_longjmp_master:
4792 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
4793 break;
4794 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
4795 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
4796 break;
4797 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4798 case bp_read_watchpoint:
4799 case bp_access_watchpoint:
4800 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint;
4801 break;
4802 case bp_watchpoint:
4803 case bp_catchpoint:
4804 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_other;
4805 break;
4806 default:
4807 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
4808 }
4809
4810 return loc;
4811 }
4812
4813 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc)
4814 {
4815 if (loc->cond)
4816 xfree (loc->cond);
4817
4818 if (loc->function_name)
4819 xfree (loc->function_name);
4820
4821 xfree (loc);
4822 }
4823
4824 /* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below. Creates a breakpoint
4825 that has type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet. */
4826 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made static. */
4827
4828 static struct breakpoint *
4829 set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
4830 enum bptype bptype)
4831 {
4832 struct breakpoint *b, *b1;
4833
4834 b = (struct breakpoint *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct breakpoint));
4835 memset (b, 0, sizeof (*b));
4836
4837 b->type = bptype;
4838 b->gdbarch = gdbarch;
4839 b->language = current_language->la_language;
4840 b->input_radix = input_radix;
4841 b->thread = -1;
4842 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
4843 b->next = 0;
4844 b->silent = 0;
4845 b->ignore_count = 0;
4846 b->commands = NULL;
4847 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
4848 b->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
4849 b->exec_pathname = NULL;
4850 b->syscalls_to_be_caught = NULL;
4851 b->ops = NULL;
4852 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
4853
4854 /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain
4855 so that a list of breakpoints will come out in order
4856 of increasing numbers. */
4857
4858 b1 = breakpoint_chain;
4859 if (b1 == 0)
4860 breakpoint_chain = b;
4861 else
4862 {
4863 while (b1->next)
4864 b1 = b1->next;
4865 b1->next = b;
4866 }
4867 return b;
4868 }
4869
4870 /* Initialize loc->function_name. */
4871 static void
4872 set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc)
4873 {
4874 if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint
4875 || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
4876 || loc->owner->type == bp_tracepoint)
4877 {
4878 find_pc_partial_function (loc->address, &(loc->function_name),
4879 NULL, NULL);
4880 if (loc->function_name)
4881 loc->function_name = xstrdup (loc->function_name);
4882 }
4883 }
4884
4885 /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */
4886 static struct gdbarch *
4887 get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal)
4888 {
4889 if (sal.section)
4890 return get_objfile_arch (sal.section->objfile);
4891 if (sal.symtab)
4892 return get_objfile_arch (sal.symtab->objfile);
4893
4894 return NULL;
4895 }
4896
4897 /* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
4898 partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE. The newly
4899 created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
4900 number are provided by SAL. The newly created and partially
4901 initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
4902 is also returned as the value of this function.
4903
4904 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
4905 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
4906 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. In
4907 particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
4908 number! Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
4909 prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint. If this
4910 should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain. */
4911
4912 struct breakpoint *
4913 set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
4914 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype)
4915 {
4916 struct breakpoint *b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (gdbarch, bptype);
4917 CORE_ADDR adjusted_address;
4918 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch;
4919
4920 loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
4921 if (!loc_gdbarch)
4922 loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
4923
4924 if (bptype != bp_catchpoint)
4925 gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL);
4926
4927 /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
4928 Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
4929 location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the
4930 breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
4931 not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
4932 location that's only been partially initialized. */
4933 adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch, sal.pc, b->type);
4934
4935 b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
4936 b->loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch;
4937 b->loc->requested_address = sal.pc;
4938 b->loc->address = adjusted_address;
4939 b->loc->pspace = sal.pspace;
4940
4941 /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint, for
4942 breakpoint resetting. */
4943 b->pspace = sal.pspace;
4944
4945 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
4946 b->source_file = NULL;
4947 else
4948 b->source_file = xstrdup (sal.symtab->filename);
4949 b->loc->section = sal.section;
4950 b->line_number = sal.line;
4951
4952 set_breakpoint_location_function (b->loc);
4953
4954 breakpoints_changed ();
4955
4956 return b;
4957 }
4958
4959
4960 /* Note that the breakpoint object B describes a permanent breakpoint
4961 instruction, hard-wired into the inferior's code. */
4962 void
4963 make_breakpoint_permanent (struct breakpoint *b)
4964 {
4965 struct bp_location *bl;
4966 b->enable_state = bp_permanent;
4967
4968 /* By definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the code.
4969 Mark all locations as inserted. For now, make_breakpoint_permanent
4970 is called in just one place, so it's hard to say if it's reasonable
4971 to have permanent breakpoint with multiple locations or not,
4972 but it's easy to implmement. */
4973 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
4974 bl->inserted = 1;
4975 }
4976
4977 /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
4978 if we do a longjmp() in THREAD. When we hit that breakpoint, call
4979 set_longjmp_resume_breakpoint() to figure out where we are going. */
4980
4981 void
4982 set_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
4983 {
4984 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
4985
4986 /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
4987 we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
4988 longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary
4989 clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */
4990 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
4991 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
4992 && b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
4993 {
4994 struct breakpoint *clone = clone_momentary_breakpoint (b);
4995 clone->type = bp_longjmp;
4996 clone->thread = thread;
4997 }
4998 }
4999
5000 /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */
5001 void
5002 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
5003 {
5004 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5005
5006 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5007 if (b->type == bp_longjmp)
5008 {
5009 if (b->thread == thread)
5010 delete_breakpoint (b);
5011 }
5012 }
5013
5014 void
5015 enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
5016 {
5017 struct breakpoint *b;
5018
5019 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5020 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
5021 {
5022 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5023 update_global_location_list (1);
5024 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
5025 }
5026 }
5027
5028 void
5029 disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
5030 {
5031 struct breakpoint *b;
5032
5033 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5034 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
5035 {
5036 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
5037 update_global_location_list (0);
5038 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
5039 }
5040 }
5041
5042 struct breakpoint *
5043 create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5044 {
5045 struct breakpoint *b;
5046
5047 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event);
5048
5049 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5050 /* addr_string has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */
5051 b->addr_string
5052 = xstrprintf ("*%s", paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address));
5053
5054 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5055
5056 return b;
5057 }
5058
5059 void
5060 remove_thread_event_breakpoints (void)
5061 {
5062 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5063
5064 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5065 if (b->type == bp_thread_event
5066 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
5067 delete_breakpoint (b);
5068 }
5069
5070 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args
5071 {
5072 char **arg_p;
5073 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals_p;
5074 char ***addr_string_p;
5075 int *not_found_ptr;
5076 };
5077
5078 struct lang_and_radix
5079 {
5080 enum language lang;
5081 int radix;
5082 };
5083
5084 /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */
5085
5086 struct breakpoint *
5087 create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5088 {
5089 struct breakpoint *b;
5090
5091 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event);
5092 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5093 return b;
5094 }
5095
5096 void
5097 remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
5098 {
5099 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5100
5101 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5102 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
5103 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
5104 delete_breakpoint (b);
5105 }
5106
5107 struct breakpoint *
5108 create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5109 {
5110 struct breakpoint *b;
5111
5112 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event);
5113 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5114 return b;
5115 }
5116
5117 /* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only
5118 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
5119
5120 void
5121 disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
5122 {
5123 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
5124
5125 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
5126 {
5127 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
5128 /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled
5129 for those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint
5130 becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to insert
5131 all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here, we'll try
5132 to insert those breakpoints and fail. */
5133 if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint)
5134 || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5135 || (b->type == bp_tracepoint))
5136 && loc->pspace == current_program_space
5137 && !loc->shlib_disabled
5138 #ifdef PC_SOLIB
5139 && PC_SOLIB (loc->address)
5140 #else
5141 && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address)
5142 #endif
5143 )
5144 {
5145 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
5146 }
5147 }
5148 }
5149
5150 /* Disable any breakpoints that are in in an unloaded shared library. Only
5151 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
5152
5153 static void
5154 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib)
5155 {
5156 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
5157 int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0;
5158
5159 /* SunOS a.out shared libraries are always mapped, so do not
5160 disable breakpoints; they will only be reported as unloaded
5161 through clear_solib when GDB discards its shared library
5162 list. See clear_solib for more information. */
5163 if (exec_bfd != NULL
5164 && bfd_get_flavour (exec_bfd) == bfd_target_aout_flavour)
5165 return;
5166
5167 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
5168 {
5169 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
5170 if ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
5171 || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
5172 && solib->pspace == loc->pspace
5173 && !loc->shlib_disabled
5174 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5175 && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address))
5176 {
5177 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
5178 /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
5179 succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
5180 to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */
5181 loc->inserted = 0;
5182 if (!disabled_shlib_breaks)
5183 {
5184 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
5185 warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
5186 solib->so_name);
5187 }
5188 disabled_shlib_breaks = 1;
5189 }
5190 }
5191 }
5192
5193 /* FORK & VFORK catchpoints. */
5194
5195 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5196
5197 static void
5198 insert_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5199 {
5200 target_insert_fork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5201 }
5202
5203 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5204
5205 static int
5206 remove_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5207 {
5208 return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5209 }
5210
5211 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork
5212 catchpoints. */
5213
5214 static int
5215 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5216 {
5217 return inferior_has_forked (inferior_ptid, &b->forked_inferior_pid);
5218 }
5219
5220 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5221
5222 static enum print_stop_action
5223 print_it_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5224 {
5225 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5226 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (forked process %d), "),
5227 b->number, ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5228 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5229 }
5230
5231 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5232
5233 static void
5234 print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
5235 {
5236 struct value_print_options opts;
5237
5238 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5239
5240 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5241 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5242 is relatively readable). */
5243 if (opts.addressprint)
5244 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5245 annotate_field (5);
5246 ui_out_text (uiout, "fork");
5247 if (!ptid_equal (b->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
5248 {
5249 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
5250 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
5251 ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5252 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
5253 }
5254 }
5255
5256 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork
5257 catchpoints. */
5258
5259 static void
5260 print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5261 {
5262 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b->number);
5263 }
5264
5265 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints. */
5266
5267 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops =
5268 {
5269 insert_catch_fork,
5270 remove_catch_fork,
5271 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork,
5272 print_it_catch_fork,
5273 print_one_catch_fork,
5274 print_mention_catch_fork
5275 };
5276
5277 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5278
5279 static void
5280 insert_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5281 {
5282 target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5283 }
5284
5285 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5286
5287 static int
5288 remove_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5289 {
5290 return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5291 }
5292
5293 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
5294 catchpoints. */
5295
5296 static int
5297 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5298 {
5299 return inferior_has_vforked (inferior_ptid, &b->forked_inferior_pid);
5300 }
5301
5302 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5303
5304 static enum print_stop_action
5305 print_it_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5306 {
5307 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5308 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (vforked process %d), "),
5309 b->number, ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5310 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5311 }
5312
5313 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5314
5315 static void
5316 print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
5317 {
5318 struct value_print_options opts;
5319
5320 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5321 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5322 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5323 is relatively readable). */
5324 if (opts.addressprint)
5325 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5326 annotate_field (5);
5327 ui_out_text (uiout, "vfork");
5328 if (!ptid_equal (b->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
5329 {
5330 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
5331 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
5332 ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5333 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
5334 }
5335 }
5336
5337 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
5338 catchpoints. */
5339
5340 static void
5341 print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5342 {
5343 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b->number);
5344 }
5345
5346 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints. */
5347
5348 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops =
5349 {
5350 insert_catch_vfork,
5351 remove_catch_vfork,
5352 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork,
5353 print_it_catch_vfork,
5354 print_one_catch_vfork,
5355 print_mention_catch_vfork
5356 };
5357
5358 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5359 catchpoints. */
5360
5361 static void
5362 insert_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5363 {
5364 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
5365
5366 ++inf->total_syscalls_count;
5367 if (!b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5368 ++inf->any_syscall_count;
5369 else
5370 {
5371 int i, iter;
5372 for (i = 0;
5373 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5374 i++)
5375 {
5376 int elem;
5377 if (iter >= VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts))
5378 {
5379 int old_size = VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts);
5380 uintptr_t vec_addr_offset = old_size * ((uintptr_t) sizeof (int));
5381 uintptr_t vec_addr;
5382 VEC_safe_grow (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter + 1);
5383 vec_addr = (uintptr_t) VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts) +
5384 vec_addr_offset;
5385 memset ((void *) vec_addr, 0,
5386 (iter + 1 - old_size) * sizeof (int));
5387 }
5388 elem = VEC_index (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter);
5389 VEC_replace (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter, ++elem);
5390 }
5391 }
5392
5393 target_set_syscall_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid),
5394 inf->total_syscalls_count != 0,
5395 inf->any_syscall_count,
5396 VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts),
5397 VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts));
5398 }
5399
5400 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5401 catchpoints. */
5402
5403 static int
5404 remove_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5405 {
5406 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
5407
5408 --inf->total_syscalls_count;
5409 if (!b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5410 --inf->any_syscall_count;
5411 else
5412 {
5413 int i, iter;
5414 for (i = 0;
5415 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5416 i++)
5417 {
5418 int elem;
5419 if (iter >= VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts))
5420 /* Shouldn't happen. */
5421 continue;
5422 elem = VEC_index (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter);
5423 VEC_replace (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter, --elem);
5424 }
5425 }
5426
5427 return target_set_syscall_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid),
5428 inf->total_syscalls_count != 0,
5429 inf->any_syscall_count,
5430 VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts),
5431 VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts));
5432 }
5433
5434 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5435 catchpoints. */
5436
5437 static int
5438 breakpoint_hit_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5439 {
5440 /* We must check if we are catching specific syscalls in this breakpoint.
5441 If we are, then we must guarantee that the called syscall is the same
5442 syscall we are catching. */
5443 int syscall_number = 0;
5444
5445 if (!inferior_has_called_syscall (inferior_ptid, &syscall_number))
5446 return 0;
5447
5448 /* Now, checking if the syscall is the same. */
5449 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5450 {
5451 int i, iter;
5452 for (i = 0;
5453 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5454 i++)
5455 if (syscall_number == iter)
5456 break;
5457 /* Not the same. */
5458 if (!iter)
5459 return 0;
5460 }
5461
5462 return 1;
5463 }
5464
5465 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5466 catchpoints. */
5467
5468 static enum print_stop_action
5469 print_it_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5470 {
5471 /* These are needed because we want to know in which state a
5472 syscall is. It can be in the TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY
5473 or TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_RETURN, and depending on it we
5474 must print "called syscall" or "returned from syscall". */
5475 ptid_t ptid;
5476 struct target_waitstatus last;
5477 struct syscall s;
5478 struct cleanup *old_chain;
5479 char *syscall_id;
5480
5481 get_last_target_status (&ptid, &last);
5482
5483 get_syscall_by_number (last.value.syscall_number, &s);
5484
5485 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5486
5487 if (s.name == NULL)
5488 syscall_id = xstrprintf ("%d", last.value.syscall_number);
5489 else
5490 syscall_id = xstrprintf ("'%s'", s.name);
5491
5492 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, syscall_id);
5493
5494 if (last.kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY)
5495 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (call to syscall %s), "),
5496 b->number, syscall_id);
5497 else if (last.kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_RETURN)
5498 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (returned from syscall %s), "),
5499 b->number, syscall_id);
5500
5501 do_cleanups (old_chain);
5502
5503 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5504 }
5505
5506 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5507 catchpoints. */
5508
5509 static void
5510 print_one_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b,
5511 struct bp_location **last_loc)
5512 {
5513 struct value_print_options opts;
5514
5515 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5516 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5517 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5518 is relatively readable). */
5519 if (opts.addressprint)
5520 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5521 annotate_field (5);
5522
5523 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught
5524 && VEC_length (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught) > 1)
5525 ui_out_text (uiout, "syscalls \"");
5526 else
5527 ui_out_text (uiout, "syscall \"");
5528
5529 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5530 {
5531 int i, iter;
5532 char *text = xstrprintf ("%s", "");
5533 for (i = 0;
5534 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5535 i++)
5536 {
5537 char *x = text;
5538 struct syscall s;
5539 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
5540
5541 if (s.name != NULL)
5542 text = xstrprintf ("%s%s, ", text, s.name);
5543 else
5544 text = xstrprintf ("%s%d, ", text, iter);
5545
5546 /* We have to xfree the last 'text' (now stored at 'x')
5547 because xstrprintf dinamically allocates new space for it
5548 on every call. */
5549 xfree (x);
5550 }
5551 /* Remove the last comma. */
5552 text[strlen (text) - 2] = '\0';
5553 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", text);
5554 }
5555 else
5556 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "<any syscall>");
5557 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
5558 }
5559
5560 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5561 catchpoints. */
5562
5563 static void
5564 print_mention_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5565 {
5566 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5567 {
5568 int i, iter;
5569
5570 if (VEC_length (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught) > 1)
5571 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (syscalls"), b->number);
5572 else
5573 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (syscall"), b->number);
5574
5575 for (i = 0;
5576 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5577 i++)
5578 {
5579 struct syscall s;
5580 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
5581
5582 if (s.name)
5583 printf_filtered (" '%s' [%d]", s.name, s.number);
5584 else
5585 printf_filtered (" %d", s.number);
5586 }
5587 printf_filtered (")");
5588 }
5589 else
5590 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (any syscall)"),
5591 b->number);
5592 }
5593
5594 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in syscall catchpoints. */
5595
5596 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops =
5597 {
5598 insert_catch_syscall,
5599 remove_catch_syscall,
5600 breakpoint_hit_catch_syscall,
5601 print_it_catch_syscall,
5602 print_one_catch_syscall,
5603 print_mention_catch_syscall
5604 };
5605
5606 /* Returns non-zero if 'b' is a syscall catchpoint. */
5607
5608 static int
5609 syscall_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
5610 {
5611 return (b->ops == &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops);
5612 }
5613
5614 /* Create a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind and return it,
5615 but does NOT mention it nor update the global location list.
5616 This is useful if you need to fill more fields in the
5617 struct breakpoint before calling mention.
5618
5619 If TEMPFLAG is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary.
5620 If COND_STRING is not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint.
5621 OPS, if not NULL, is the breakpoint_ops structure associated
5622 to the catchpoint. */
5623
5624 static struct breakpoint *
5625 create_catchpoint_without_mention (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
5626 char *cond_string,
5627 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5628 {
5629 struct symtab_and_line sal;
5630 struct breakpoint *b;
5631
5632 init_sal (&sal);
5633 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
5634
5635 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint);
5636 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
5637 b->number = breakpoint_count;
5638
5639 b->cond_string = (cond_string == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup (cond_string);
5640 b->thread = -1;
5641 b->addr_string = NULL;
5642 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5643 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
5644 b->ops = ops;
5645
5646 return b;
5647 }
5648
5649 /* Create a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind and return it.
5650
5651 If TEMPFLAG is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary.
5652 If COND_STRING is not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint.
5653 OPS, if not NULL, is the breakpoint_ops structure associated
5654 to the catchpoint. */
5655
5656 static struct breakpoint *
5657 create_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
5658 char *cond_string, struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5659 {
5660 struct breakpoint *b =
5661 create_catchpoint_without_mention (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
5662
5663 mention (b);
5664 update_global_location_list (1);
5665
5666 return b;
5667 }
5668
5669 static void
5670 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
5671 int tempflag, char *cond_string,
5672 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5673 {
5674 struct breakpoint *b
5675 = create_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
5676
5677 /* FIXME: We should put this information in a breakpoint private data
5678 area. */
5679 b->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
5680 }
5681
5682 /* Exec catchpoints. */
5683
5684 static void
5685 insert_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5686 {
5687 target_insert_exec_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5688 }
5689
5690 static int
5691 remove_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5692 {
5693 return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5694 }
5695
5696 static int
5697 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5698 {
5699 return inferior_has_execd (inferior_ptid, &b->exec_pathname);
5700 }
5701
5702 static enum print_stop_action
5703 print_it_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5704 {
5705 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5706 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (exec'd %s), "), b->number,
5707 b->exec_pathname);
5708 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5709 }
5710
5711 static void
5712 print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
5713 {
5714 struct value_print_options opts;
5715
5716 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5717
5718 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5719 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5720 is relatively readable). */
5721 if (opts.addressprint)
5722 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5723 annotate_field (5);
5724 ui_out_text (uiout, "exec");
5725 if (b->exec_pathname != NULL)
5726 {
5727 ui_out_text (uiout, ", program \"");
5728 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", b->exec_pathname);
5729 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
5730 }
5731 }
5732
5733 static void
5734 print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5735 {
5736 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b->number);
5737 }
5738
5739 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops =
5740 {
5741 insert_catch_exec,
5742 remove_catch_exec,
5743 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec,
5744 print_it_catch_exec,
5745 print_one_catch_exec,
5746 print_mention_catch_exec
5747 };
5748
5749 static void
5750 create_syscall_event_catchpoint (int tempflag, VEC(int) *filter,
5751 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5752 {
5753 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
5754 struct breakpoint *b =
5755 create_catchpoint_without_mention (gdbarch, tempflag, NULL, ops);
5756
5757 b->syscalls_to_be_caught = filter;
5758
5759 /* Now, we have to mention the breakpoint and update the global
5760 location list. */
5761 mention (b);
5762 update_global_location_list (1);
5763 }
5764
5765 static int
5766 hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
5767 {
5768 struct breakpoint *b;
5769 int i = 0;
5770
5771 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5772 {
5773 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b))
5774 i++;
5775 }
5776
5777 return i;
5778 }
5779
5780 static int
5781 hw_watchpoint_used_count (enum bptype type, int *other_type_used)
5782 {
5783 struct breakpoint *b;
5784 int i = 0;
5785
5786 *other_type_used = 0;
5787 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5788 {
5789 if (breakpoint_enabled (b))
5790 {
5791 if (b->type == type)
5792 i++;
5793 else if ((b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5794 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
5795 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint))
5796 *other_type_used = 1;
5797 }
5798 }
5799 return i;
5800 }
5801
5802 void
5803 disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
5804 {
5805 struct breakpoint *b;
5806
5807 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5808 {
5809 if (((b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5810 || (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
5811 || (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
5812 || (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint))
5813 && breakpoint_enabled (b))
5814 {
5815 b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled;
5816 update_global_location_list (0);
5817 }
5818 }
5819 }
5820
5821 void
5822 enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
5823 {
5824 struct breakpoint *b;
5825
5826 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5827 {
5828 if (((b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5829 || (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
5830 || (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
5831 || (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint))
5832 && (b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled))
5833 {
5834 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5835 update_global_location_list (1);
5836 }
5837 }
5838 }
5839
5840 void
5841 disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
5842 {
5843 struct breakpoint *b;
5844 int found = 0;
5845
5846 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5847 {
5848 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
5849 continue;
5850
5851 if ((b->type == bp_breakpoint
5852 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5853 && breakpoint_enabled (b))
5854 {
5855 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
5856 found = 1;
5857 }
5858 }
5859
5860 if (found)
5861 update_global_location_list (0);
5862
5863 current_program_space->executing_startup = 1;
5864 }
5865
5866 void
5867 enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
5868 {
5869 struct breakpoint *b;
5870 int found = 0;
5871
5872 current_program_space->executing_startup = 0;
5873
5874 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5875 {
5876 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
5877 continue;
5878
5879 if ((b->type == bp_breakpoint
5880 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5881 && b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
5882 {
5883 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5884 found = 1;
5885 }
5886 }
5887
5888 if (found)
5889 breakpoint_re_set ();
5890 }
5891
5892
5893 /* Set a breakpoint that will evaporate an end of command
5894 at address specified by SAL.
5895 Restrict it to frame FRAME if FRAME is nonzero. */
5896
5897 struct breakpoint *
5898 set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal,
5899 struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type)
5900 {
5901 struct breakpoint *b;
5902
5903 /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined
5904 one. */
5905 gdb_assert (!frame_id_inlined_p (frame_id));
5906
5907 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
5908 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5909 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
5910 b->frame_id = frame_id;
5911
5912 /* If we're debugging a multi-threaded program, then we
5913 want momentary breakpoints to be active in only a
5914 single thread of control. */
5915 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
5916 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
5917
5918 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5919
5920 return b;
5921 }
5922
5923 /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if
5924 ORIG is NULL. */
5925
5926 struct breakpoint *
5927 clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig)
5928 {
5929 struct breakpoint *copy;
5930
5931 /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */
5932 if (orig == NULL)
5933 return NULL;
5934
5935 copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, orig->type);
5936 copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy);
5937 set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc);
5938
5939 copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch;
5940 copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address;
5941 copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address;
5942 copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section;
5943 copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace;
5944
5945 if (orig->source_file == NULL)
5946 copy->source_file = NULL;
5947 else
5948 copy->source_file = xstrdup (orig->source_file);
5949
5950 copy->line_number = orig->line_number;
5951 copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id;
5952 copy->thread = orig->thread;
5953 copy->pspace = orig->pspace;
5954
5955 copy->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5956 copy->disposition = disp_donttouch;
5957 copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
5958
5959 update_global_location_list_nothrow (0);
5960 return copy;
5961 }
5962
5963 struct breakpoint *
5964 set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc,
5965 enum bptype type)
5966 {
5967 struct symtab_and_line sal;
5968
5969 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
5970 sal.pc = pc;
5971 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
5972 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
5973
5974 return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type);
5975 }
5976 \f
5977
5978 /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */
5979
5980 static void
5981 mention (struct breakpoint *b)
5982 {
5983 int say_where = 0;
5984 struct cleanup *ui_out_chain;
5985 struct value_print_options opts;
5986
5987 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5988
5989 /* FIXME: This is misplaced; mention() is called by things (like
5990 hitting a watchpoint) other than breakpoint creation. It should
5991 be possible to clean this up and at the same time replace the
5992 random calls to breakpoint_changed with this hook. */
5993 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b->number);
5994
5995 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_mention != NULL)
5996 b->ops->print_mention (b);
5997 else
5998 switch (b->type)
5999 {
6000 case bp_none:
6001 printf_filtered (_("(apparently deleted?) Eventpoint %d: "), b->number);
6002 break;
6003 case bp_watchpoint:
6004 ui_out_text (uiout, "Watchpoint ");
6005 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
6006 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6007 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6008 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6009 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6010 break;
6011 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
6012 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware watchpoint ");
6013 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
6014 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6015 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6016 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6017 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6018 break;
6019 case bp_read_watchpoint:
6020 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware read watchpoint ");
6021 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-rwpt");
6022 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6023 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6024 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6025 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6026 break;
6027 case bp_access_watchpoint:
6028 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
6029 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-awpt");
6030 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6031 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6032 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6033 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6034 break;
6035 case bp_breakpoint:
6036 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6037 {
6038 say_where = 0;
6039 break;
6040 }
6041 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
6042 printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
6043 else
6044 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint"));
6045 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6046 say_where = 1;
6047 break;
6048 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
6049 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6050 {
6051 say_where = 0;
6052 break;
6053 }
6054 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number);
6055 say_where = 1;
6056 break;
6057 case bp_tracepoint:
6058 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6059 {
6060 say_where = 0;
6061 break;
6062 }
6063 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint"));
6064 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6065 say_where = 1;
6066 break;
6067
6068 case bp_until:
6069 case bp_finish:
6070 case bp_longjmp:
6071 case bp_longjmp_resume:
6072 case bp_step_resume:
6073 case bp_call_dummy:
6074 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
6075 case bp_shlib_event:
6076 case bp_thread_event:
6077 case bp_overlay_event:
6078 case bp_jit_event:
6079 case bp_longjmp_master:
6080 break;
6081 }
6082
6083 if (say_where)
6084 {
6085 /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
6086 single string. */
6087 if (b->loc == NULL)
6088 {
6089 printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."), b->addr_string);
6090 }
6091 else
6092 {
6093 if (opts.addressprint || b->source_file == NULL)
6094 {
6095 printf_filtered (" at ");
6096 fputs_filtered (paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address),
6097 gdb_stdout);
6098 }
6099 if (b->source_file)
6100 printf_filtered (": file %s, line %d.",
6101 b->source_file, b->line_number);
6102
6103 if (b->loc->next)
6104 {
6105 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
6106 int n = 0;
6107 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
6108 ++n;
6109 printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n);
6110 }
6111
6112 }
6113 }
6114 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6115 return;
6116 printf_filtered ("\n");
6117 }
6118 \f
6119
6120 static struct bp_location *
6121 add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
6122 const struct symtab_and_line *sal)
6123 {
6124 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
6125
6126 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
6127 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
6128 ;
6129 *tmp = loc;
6130 loc->gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
6131 if (!loc->gdbarch)
6132 loc->gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
6133 loc->requested_address = sal->pc;
6134 loc->address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc->gdbarch,
6135 loc->requested_address, b->type);
6136 loc->pspace = sal->pspace;
6137 gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL);
6138 loc->section = sal->section;
6139
6140 set_breakpoint_location_function (loc);
6141 return loc;
6142 }
6143 \f
6144
6145 /* Return 1 if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
6146 return 0 otherwise. */
6147
6148 static int
6149 bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc)
6150 {
6151 int len;
6152 CORE_ADDR addr;
6153 const gdb_byte *brk;
6154 gdb_byte *target_mem;
6155 struct cleanup *cleanup;
6156 int retval = 0;
6157
6158 gdb_assert (loc != NULL);
6159
6160 addr = loc->address;
6161 brk = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (loc->gdbarch, &addr, &len);
6162
6163 /* Software breakpoints unsupported? */
6164 if (brk == NULL)
6165 return 0;
6166
6167 target_mem = alloca (len);
6168
6169 /* Enable the automatic memory restoration from breakpoints while
6170 we read the memory. Otherwise we could say about our temporary
6171 breakpoints they are permanent. */
6172 cleanup = save_current_space_and_thread ();
6173
6174 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace);
6175 make_show_memory_breakpoints_cleanup (0);
6176
6177 if (target_read_memory (loc->address, target_mem, len) == 0
6178 && memcmp (target_mem, brk, len) == 0)
6179 retval = 1;
6180
6181 do_cleanups (cleanup);
6182
6183 return retval;
6184 }
6185
6186
6187
6188 /* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location. Use ADDR_STRING
6189 as textual description of the location, and COND_STRING
6190 as condition expression. */
6191
6192 static void
6193 create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6194 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, char *addr_string,
6195 char *cond_string,
6196 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
6197 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
6198 struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty, int enabled)
6199 {
6200 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
6201 int i;
6202
6203 if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
6204 {
6205 int i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
6206 int target_resources_ok =
6207 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
6208 i + 1, 0);
6209 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
6210 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
6211 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
6212 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
6213 }
6214
6215 gdb_assert (sals.nelts > 0);
6216
6217 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
6218 {
6219 struct symtab_and_line sal = sals.sals[i];
6220 struct bp_location *loc;
6221
6222 if (from_tty)
6223 {
6224 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
6225 if (!loc_gdbarch)
6226 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
6227
6228 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
6229 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread);
6230 }
6231
6232 if (i == 0)
6233 {
6234 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
6235 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
6236 b->number = breakpoint_count;
6237 b->thread = thread;
6238 b->task = task;
6239
6240 b->cond_string = cond_string;
6241 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
6242 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
6243 b->disposition = disposition;
6244
6245 b->pspace = sals.sals[0].pspace;
6246
6247 if (enabled && b->pspace->executing_startup
6248 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint
6249 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint))
6250 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
6251
6252 loc = b->loc;
6253 }
6254 else
6255 {
6256 loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
6257 }
6258
6259 if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc))
6260 make_breakpoint_permanent (b);
6261
6262 if (b->cond_string)
6263 {
6264 char *arg = b->cond_string;
6265 loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&arg, block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
6266 if (*arg)
6267 error (_("Garbage %s follows condition"), arg);
6268 }
6269 }
6270
6271 if (addr_string)
6272 b->addr_string = addr_string;
6273 else
6274 /* addr_string has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete
6275 me. */
6276 b->addr_string
6277 = xstrprintf ("*%s", paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address));
6278
6279 b->ops = ops;
6280 mention (b);
6281 }
6282
6283 /* Remove element at INDEX_TO_REMOVE from SAL, shifting other
6284 elements to fill the void space. */
6285 static void
6286 remove_sal (struct symtabs_and_lines *sal, int index_to_remove)
6287 {
6288 int i = index_to_remove+1;
6289 int last_index = sal->nelts-1;
6290
6291 for (;i <= last_index; ++i)
6292 sal->sals[i-1] = sal->sals[i];
6293
6294 --(sal->nelts);
6295 }
6296
6297 /* If appropriate, obtains all sals that correspond to the same file
6298 and line as SAL, in all program spaces. Users debugging with IDEs,
6299 will want to set a breakpoint at foo.c:line, and not really care
6300 about program spaces. This is done only if SAL does not have
6301 explicit PC and has line and file information. If we got just a
6302 single expanded sal, return the original.
6303
6304 Otherwise, if SAL.explicit_line is not set, filter out all sals for
6305 which the name of enclosing function is different from SAL. This
6306 makes sure that if we have breakpoint originally set in template
6307 instantiation, say foo<int>(), we won't expand SAL to locations at
6308 the same line in all existing instantiations of 'foo'. */
6309
6310 static struct symtabs_and_lines
6311 expand_line_sal_maybe (struct symtab_and_line sal)
6312 {
6313 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded;
6314 CORE_ADDR original_pc = sal.pc;
6315 char *original_function = NULL;
6316 int found;
6317 int i;
6318 struct cleanup *old_chain;
6319
6320 /* If we have explicit pc, don't expand.
6321 If we have no line number, we can't expand. */
6322 if (sal.explicit_pc || sal.line == 0 || sal.symtab == NULL)
6323 {
6324 expanded.nelts = 1;
6325 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6326 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
6327 return expanded;
6328 }
6329
6330 sal.pc = 0;
6331
6332 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
6333
6334 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal.pspace);
6335
6336 find_pc_partial_function (original_pc, &original_function, NULL, NULL);
6337
6338 /* Note that expand_line_sal visits *all* program spaces. */
6339 expanded = expand_line_sal (sal);
6340
6341 if (expanded.nelts == 1)
6342 {
6343 /* We had one sal, we got one sal. Return that sal, adjusting it
6344 past the function prologue if necessary. */
6345 xfree (expanded.sals);
6346 expanded.nelts = 1;
6347 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6348 sal.pc = original_pc;
6349 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
6350 skip_prologue_sal (&expanded.sals[0]);
6351 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6352 return expanded;
6353 }
6354
6355 if (!sal.explicit_line)
6356 {
6357 CORE_ADDR func_addr, func_end;
6358 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
6359 {
6360 CORE_ADDR pc = expanded.sals[i].pc;
6361 char *this_function;
6362
6363 /* We need to switch threads as well since we're about to
6364 read memory. */
6365 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (expanded.sals[i].pspace);
6366
6367 if (find_pc_partial_function (pc, &this_function,
6368 &func_addr, &func_end))
6369 {
6370 if (this_function
6371 && strcmp (this_function, original_function) != 0)
6372 {
6373 remove_sal (&expanded, i);
6374 --i;
6375 }
6376 else if (func_addr == pc)
6377 {
6378 /* We're at beginning of a function, and should
6379 skip prologue. */
6380 struct symbol *sym = find_pc_function (pc);
6381 if (sym)
6382 expanded.sals[i] = find_function_start_sal (sym, 1);
6383 else
6384 {
6385 /* Since find_pc_partial_function returned true,
6386 we should really always find the section here. */
6387 struct obj_section *section = find_pc_section (pc);
6388 if (section)
6389 {
6390 struct gdbarch *gdbarch
6391 = get_objfile_arch (section->objfile);
6392 expanded.sals[i].pc
6393 = gdbarch_skip_prologue (gdbarch, pc);
6394 }
6395 }
6396 }
6397 }
6398 }
6399 }
6400 else
6401 {
6402 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
6403 {
6404 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a
6405 line number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
6406 skip_prologue_sal (&expanded.sals[i]);
6407 }
6408 }
6409
6410 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6411
6412 if (expanded.nelts <= 1)
6413 {
6414 /* This is un ugly workaround. If we get zero
6415 expanded sals then something is really wrong.
6416 Fix that by returnign the original sal. */
6417 xfree (expanded.sals);
6418 expanded.nelts = 1;
6419 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6420 sal.pc = original_pc;
6421 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
6422 return expanded;
6423 }
6424
6425 if (original_pc)
6426 {
6427 found = 0;
6428 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
6429 if (expanded.sals[i].pc == original_pc)
6430 {
6431 found = 1;
6432 break;
6433 }
6434 gdb_assert (found);
6435 }
6436
6437 return expanded;
6438 }
6439
6440 /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each
6441 SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
6442 value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
6443 used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where
6444 SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
6445 function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify
6446 separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
6447 we take just a single condition string.
6448
6449 NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
6450 the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
6451 array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the
6452 caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
6453 COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
6454
6455 static void
6456 create_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6457 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, char **addr_string,
6458 char *cond_string,
6459 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
6460 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
6461 struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
6462 int enabled)
6463 {
6464 int i;
6465 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
6466 {
6467 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded =
6468 expand_line_sal_maybe (sals.sals[i]);
6469
6470 create_breakpoint (gdbarch, expanded, addr_string[i],
6471 cond_string, type, disposition,
6472 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty, enabled);
6473 }
6474 }
6475
6476 /* Parse ARG which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
6477 followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
6478 addresses found. ADDR_STRING contains a vector of (canonical)
6479 address strings. ARG points to the end of the SAL. */
6480
6481 static void
6482 parse_breakpoint_sals (char **address,
6483 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals,
6484 char ***addr_string,
6485 int *not_found_ptr)
6486 {
6487 char *addr_start = *address;
6488 *addr_string = NULL;
6489 /* If no arg given, or if first arg is 'if ', use the default
6490 breakpoint. */
6491 if ((*address) == NULL
6492 || (strncmp ((*address), "if", 2) == 0 && isspace ((*address)[2])))
6493 {
6494 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
6495 {
6496 struct symtab_and_line sal;
6497 init_sal (&sal); /* initialize to zeroes */
6498 sals->sals = (struct symtab_and_line *)
6499 xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6500 sal.pc = default_breakpoint_address;
6501 sal.line = default_breakpoint_line;
6502 sal.symtab = default_breakpoint_symtab;
6503 sal.pspace = default_breakpoint_pspace;
6504 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
6505
6506 /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC" where PC is
6507 the default_breakpoint_address. So make sure to set
6508 sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from trying to expand the list of
6509 sals to include all other instances with the same symtab and line.
6510 */
6511 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
6512
6513 sals->sals[0] = sal;
6514 sals->nelts = 1;
6515 }
6516 else
6517 error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
6518 }
6519 else
6520 {
6521 /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
6522 current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default). This
6523 should produce the results we want almost all of the time while
6524 leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
6525 ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
6526 may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '[' */
6527
6528 struct symtab_and_line cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
6529
6530 if (default_breakpoint_valid
6531 && (!cursal.symtab
6532 || ((strchr ("+-", (*address)[0]) != NULL)
6533 && ((*address)[1] != '['))))
6534 *sals = decode_line_1 (address, 1, default_breakpoint_symtab,
6535 default_breakpoint_line, addr_string,
6536 not_found_ptr);
6537 else
6538 *sals = decode_line_1 (address, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0,
6539 addr_string, not_found_ptr);
6540 }
6541 /* For any SAL that didn't have a canonical string, fill one in. */
6542 if (sals->nelts > 0 && *addr_string == NULL)
6543 *addr_string = xcalloc (sals->nelts, sizeof (char **));
6544 if (addr_start != (*address))
6545 {
6546 int i;
6547 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
6548 {
6549 /* Add the string if not present. */
6550 if ((*addr_string)[i] == NULL)
6551 (*addr_string)[i] = savestring (addr_start, (*address) - addr_start);
6552 }
6553 }
6554 }
6555
6556
6557 /* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be
6558 inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */
6559
6560 static void
6561 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (struct symtabs_and_lines *sals,
6562 char *address)
6563 {
6564 int i;
6565 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
6566 resolve_sal_pc (&sals->sals[i]);
6567 }
6568
6569 static void
6570 do_captured_parse_breakpoint (struct ui_out *ui, void *data)
6571 {
6572 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args *args = data;
6573
6574 parse_breakpoint_sals (args->arg_p, args->sals_p, args->addr_string_p,
6575 args->not_found_ptr);
6576 }
6577
6578 /* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
6579 accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
6580 string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
6581 PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
6582 If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
6583 If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */
6584 static void
6585 find_condition_and_thread (char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc,
6586 char **cond_string, int *thread, int *task)
6587 {
6588 *cond_string = NULL;
6589 *thread = -1;
6590 while (tok && *tok)
6591 {
6592 char *end_tok;
6593 int toklen;
6594 char *cond_start = NULL;
6595 char *cond_end = NULL;
6596 while (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t')
6597 tok++;
6598
6599 end_tok = tok;
6600
6601 while (*end_tok != ' ' && *end_tok != '\t' && *end_tok != '\000')
6602 end_tok++;
6603
6604 toklen = end_tok - tok;
6605
6606 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
6607 {
6608 struct expression *expr;
6609
6610 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
6611 expr = parse_exp_1 (&tok, block_for_pc (pc), 0);
6612 xfree (expr);
6613 cond_end = tok;
6614 *cond_string = savestring (cond_start,
6615 cond_end - cond_start);
6616 }
6617 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
6618 {
6619 char *tmptok;
6620
6621 tok = end_tok + 1;
6622 tmptok = tok;
6623 *thread = strtol (tok, &tok, 0);
6624 if (tok == tmptok)
6625 error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
6626 if (!valid_thread_id (*thread))
6627 error (_("Unknown thread %d."), *thread);
6628 }
6629 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0)
6630 {
6631 char *tmptok;
6632
6633 tok = end_tok + 1;
6634 tmptok = tok;
6635 *task = strtol (tok, &tok, 0);
6636 if (tok == tmptok)
6637 error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
6638 if (!valid_task_id (*task))
6639 error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task);
6640 }
6641 else
6642 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
6643 }
6644 }
6645
6646 /* Set a breakpoint. This function is shared between
6647 CLI and MI functions for setting a breakpoint.
6648 This function has two major modes of operations,
6649 selected by the PARSE_CONDITION_AND_THREAD parameter.
6650 If non-zero, the function will parse arg, extracting
6651 breakpoint location, address and thread. Otherwise,
6652 ARG is just the location of breakpoint, with condition
6653 and thread specified by the COND_STRING and THREAD
6654 parameters. */
6655
6656 static void
6657 break_command_really (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6658 char *arg, char *cond_string, int thread,
6659 int parse_condition_and_thread,
6660 int tempflag, int hardwareflag, int traceflag,
6661 int ignore_count,
6662 enum auto_boolean pending_break_support,
6663 struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
6664 int from_tty,
6665 int enabled)
6666 {
6667 struct gdb_exception e;
6668 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
6669 struct symtab_and_line pending_sal;
6670 char *copy_arg;
6671 char *err_msg;
6672 char *addr_start = arg;
6673 char **addr_string;
6674 struct cleanup *old_chain;
6675 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain = NULL;
6676 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args parse_args;
6677 int i;
6678 int pending = 0;
6679 int not_found = 0;
6680 enum bptype type_wanted;
6681 int task = 0;
6682
6683 sals.sals = NULL;
6684 sals.nelts = 0;
6685 addr_string = NULL;
6686
6687 parse_args.arg_p = &arg;
6688 parse_args.sals_p = &sals;
6689 parse_args.addr_string_p = &addr_string;
6690 parse_args.not_found_ptr = &not_found;
6691
6692 e = catch_exception (uiout, do_captured_parse_breakpoint,
6693 &parse_args, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
6694
6695 /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set value. */
6696 switch (e.reason)
6697 {
6698 case RETURN_QUIT:
6699 throw_exception (e);
6700 case RETURN_ERROR:
6701 switch (e.error)
6702 {
6703 case NOT_FOUND_ERROR:
6704
6705 /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
6706 error. */
6707
6708 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE)
6709 throw_exception (e);
6710
6711 exception_print (gdb_stderr, e);
6712
6713 /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
6714 selects no, then simply return the error code. */
6715 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
6716 && !nquery ("Make breakpoint pending on future shared library load? "))
6717 return;
6718
6719 /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
6720 a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
6721 breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
6722 is defaulted on behalf of the user. */
6723 copy_arg = xstrdup (addr_start);
6724 addr_string = &copy_arg;
6725 sals.nelts = 1;
6726 sals.sals = &pending_sal;
6727 pending_sal.pc = 0;
6728 pending = 1;
6729 break;
6730 default:
6731 throw_exception (e);
6732 }
6733 default:
6734 if (!sals.nelts)
6735 return;
6736 }
6737
6738 /* Create a chain of things that always need to be cleaned up. */
6739 old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
6740
6741 if (!pending)
6742 {
6743 /* Make sure that all storage allocated to SALS gets freed. */
6744 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
6745
6746 /* Cleanup the addr_string array but not its contents. */
6747 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string);
6748 }
6749
6750 /* ----------------------------- SNIP -----------------------------
6751 Anything added to the cleanup chain beyond this point is assumed
6752 to be part of a breakpoint. If the breakpoint create succeeds
6753 then the memory is not reclaimed. */
6754 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
6755
6756 /* Mark the contents of the addr_string for cleanup. These go on
6757 the bkpt_chain and only occur if the breakpoint create fails. */
6758 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
6759 {
6760 if (addr_string[i] != NULL)
6761 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string[i]);
6762 }
6763
6764 /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
6765 are ok for the target. */
6766 if (!pending)
6767 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (&sals, addr_start);
6768
6769 type_wanted = (traceflag
6770 ? bp_tracepoint
6771 : (hardwareflag ? bp_hardware_breakpoint : bp_breakpoint));
6772
6773 /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
6774 breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each
6775 breakpoint. */
6776 if (!pending)
6777 {
6778 if (parse_condition_and_thread)
6779 {
6780 /* Here we only parse 'arg' to separate condition
6781 from thread number, so parsing in context of first
6782 sal is OK. When setting the breakpoint we'll
6783 re-parse it in context of each sal. */
6784 cond_string = NULL;
6785 thread = -1;
6786 find_condition_and_thread (arg, sals.sals[0].pc, &cond_string,
6787 &thread, &task);
6788 if (cond_string)
6789 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
6790 }
6791 else
6792 {
6793 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
6794 if (cond_string)
6795 {
6796 cond_string = xstrdup (cond_string);
6797 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
6798 }
6799 }
6800 create_breakpoints (gdbarch, sals, addr_string, cond_string, type_wanted,
6801 tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
6802 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty, enabled);
6803 }
6804 else
6805 {
6806 struct symtab_and_line sal = {0};
6807 struct breakpoint *b;
6808
6809 make_cleanup (xfree, copy_arg);
6810
6811 b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (gdbarch, type_wanted);
6812 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
6813 b->number = breakpoint_count;
6814 b->thread = -1;
6815 b->addr_string = addr_string[0];
6816 b->cond_string = NULL;
6817 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
6818 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
6819 b->condition_not_parsed = 1;
6820 b->ops = ops;
6821 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
6822 b->pspace = current_program_space;
6823
6824 if (enabled && b->pspace->executing_startup
6825 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint
6826 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint))
6827 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
6828
6829 mention (b);
6830 }
6831
6832 if (sals.nelts > 1)
6833 warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\n"
6834 "Use the \"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
6835 /* That's it. Discard the cleanups for data inserted into the
6836 breakpoint. */
6837 discard_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
6838 /* But cleanup everything else. */
6839 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6840
6841 /* error call may happen here - have BKPT_CHAIN already discarded. */
6842 update_global_location_list (1);
6843 }
6844
6845 /* Set a breakpoint.
6846 ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
6847 condition, and thread.
6848 FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
6849 and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
6850 and BP_TEMPFLAG. */
6851
6852 static void
6853 break_command_1 (char *arg, int flag, int from_tty)
6854 {
6855 int hardwareflag = flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG;
6856 int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG;
6857
6858 break_command_really (get_current_arch (),
6859 arg,
6860 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
6861 tempflag, hardwareflag, 0 /* traceflag */,
6862 0 /* Ignore count */,
6863 pending_break_support,
6864 NULL /* breakpoint_ops */,
6865 from_tty,
6866 1 /* enabled */);
6867 }
6868
6869
6870 void
6871 set_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6872 char *address, char *condition,
6873 int hardwareflag, int tempflag,
6874 int thread, int ignore_count,
6875 int pending, int enabled)
6876 {
6877 break_command_really (gdbarch,
6878 address, condition, thread,
6879 0 /* condition and thread are valid. */,
6880 tempflag, hardwareflag, 0 /* traceflag */,
6881 ignore_count,
6882 pending
6883 ? AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE : AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE,
6884 NULL, 0, enabled);
6885 }
6886
6887 /* Adjust SAL to the first instruction past the function prologue.
6888 The end of the prologue is determined using the line table from
6889 the debugging information. explicit_pc and explicit_line are
6890 not modified.
6891
6892 If SAL is already past the prologue, then do nothing. */
6893
6894 static void
6895 skip_prologue_sal (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
6896 {
6897 struct symbol *sym;
6898 struct symtab_and_line start_sal;
6899 struct cleanup *old_chain;
6900
6901 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
6902
6903 sym = find_pc_function (sal->pc);
6904 if (sym != NULL)
6905 {
6906 start_sal = find_function_start_sal (sym, 1);
6907 if (sal->pc < start_sal.pc)
6908 {
6909 start_sal.explicit_line = sal->explicit_line;
6910 start_sal.explicit_pc = sal->explicit_pc;
6911 *sal = start_sal;
6912 }
6913 }
6914
6915 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6916 }
6917
6918 /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */
6919
6920 void
6921 resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
6922 {
6923 CORE_ADDR pc;
6924
6925 if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
6926 {
6927 if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc))
6928 error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
6929 sal->line, sal->symtab->filename);
6930 sal->pc = pc;
6931
6932 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using
6933 a line number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
6934 if (sal->explicit_line)
6935 {
6936 /* Preserve the original line number. */
6937 int saved_line = sal->line;
6938 skip_prologue_sal (sal);
6939 sal->line = saved_line;
6940 }
6941 }
6942
6943 if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
6944 {
6945 struct blockvector *bv;
6946 struct block *b;
6947 struct symbol *sym;
6948
6949 bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b, sal->symtab);
6950 if (bv != NULL)
6951 {
6952 sym = block_linkage_function (b);
6953 if (sym != NULL)
6954 {
6955 fixup_symbol_section (sym, sal->symtab->objfile);
6956 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (sym);
6957 }
6958 else
6959 {
6960 /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll just
6961 have to look harder. This case can be executed if we have
6962 line numbers but no functions (as can happen in assembly
6963 source). */
6964
6965 struct minimal_symbol *msym;
6966 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
6967
6968 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace);
6969
6970 msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc);
6971 if (msym)
6972 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (msym);
6973
6974 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6975 }
6976 }
6977 }
6978 }
6979
6980 void
6981 break_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
6982 {
6983 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
6984 }
6985
6986 void
6987 tbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
6988 {
6989 break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty);
6990 }
6991
6992 static void
6993 hbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
6994 {
6995 break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty);
6996 }
6997
6998 static void
6999 thbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7000 {
7001 break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty);
7002 }
7003
7004 static void
7005 stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7006 {
7007 printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\
7008 Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\
7009 stop at <line>\n"));
7010 }
7011
7012 static void
7013 stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7014 {
7015 int badInput = 0;
7016
7017 if (arg == (char *) NULL)
7018 badInput = 1;
7019 else if (*arg != '*')
7020 {
7021 char *argptr = arg;
7022 int hasColon = 0;
7023
7024 /* look for a ':'. If this is a line number specification, then
7025 say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or
7026 function/method name */
7027 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
7028 {
7029 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
7030 argptr++;
7031 }
7032
7033 if (hasColon)
7034 badInput = (*argptr != ':'); /* Not a class::method */
7035 else
7036 badInput = isdigit (*arg); /* a simple line number */
7037 }
7038
7039 if (badInput)
7040 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n"));
7041 else
7042 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
7043 }
7044
7045 static void
7046 stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7047 {
7048 int badInput = 0;
7049
7050 if (arg == (char *) NULL || *arg == '*') /* no line number */
7051 badInput = 1;
7052 else
7053 {
7054 char *argptr = arg;
7055 int hasColon = 0;
7056
7057 /* look for a ':'. If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise
7058 it is probably a line number. */
7059 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
7060 {
7061 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
7062 argptr++;
7063 }
7064
7065 if (hasColon)
7066 badInput = (*argptr == ':'); /* we have class::method */
7067 else
7068 badInput = !isdigit (*arg); /* not a line number */
7069 }
7070
7071 if (badInput)
7072 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at <line>\n"));
7073 else
7074 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
7075 }
7076
7077 /* accessflag: hw_write: watch write,
7078 hw_read: watch read,
7079 hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
7080 static void
7081 watch_command_1 (char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty)
7082 {
7083 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7084 struct breakpoint *b, *scope_breakpoint = NULL;
7085 struct expression *exp;
7086 struct block *exp_valid_block;
7087 struct value *val, *mark;
7088 struct frame_info *frame;
7089 char *exp_start = NULL;
7090 char *exp_end = NULL;
7091 char *tok, *id_tok_start, *end_tok;
7092 int toklen;
7093 char *cond_start = NULL;
7094 char *cond_end = NULL;
7095 int i, other_type_used, target_resources_ok = 0;
7096 enum bptype bp_type;
7097 int mem_cnt = 0;
7098 int thread = -1;
7099
7100 /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */
7101 if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0')
7102 {
7103 toklen = strlen (arg); /* Size of argument list. */
7104
7105 /* Points tok to the end of the argument list. */
7106 tok = arg + toklen - 1;
7107
7108 /* Go backwards in the parameters list. Skip the last parameter.
7109 If we're expecting a 'thread <thread_num>' parameter, this should
7110 be the thread identifier. */
7111 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
7112 tok--;
7113 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
7114 tok--;
7115
7116 /* Points end_tok to the beginning of the last token. */
7117 id_tok_start = tok + 1;
7118
7119 /* Go backwards in the parameters list. Skip one more parameter.
7120 If we're expecting a 'thread <thread_num>' parameter, we should
7121 reach a "thread" token. */
7122 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
7123 tok--;
7124
7125 end_tok = tok;
7126
7127 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
7128 tok--;
7129
7130 /* Move the pointer forward to skip the whitespace and
7131 calculate the length of the token. */
7132 tok++;
7133 toklen = end_tok - tok;
7134
7135 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
7136 {
7137 /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
7138 the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
7139 only in a specific thread. */
7140 char *endp;
7141
7142 /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */
7143 thread = strtol (id_tok_start, &endp, 0);
7144
7145 /* Check if the user provided a valid numeric value for the
7146 thread ID. */
7147 if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
7148 error (_("Invalid thread ID specification %s."), id_tok_start);
7149
7150 /* Check if the thread actually exists. */
7151 if (!valid_thread_id (thread))
7152 error (_("Unknown thread %d."), thread);
7153
7154 /* Truncate the string and get rid of the thread <thread_num>
7155 parameter before the parameter list is parsed by the
7156 evaluate_expression() function. */
7157 *tok = '\0';
7158 }
7159 }
7160
7161 /* Parse the rest of the arguments. */
7162 innermost_block = NULL;
7163 exp_start = arg;
7164 exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0);
7165 exp_end = arg;
7166 /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
7167 This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
7168 prettier. */
7169 while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t'))
7170 --exp_end;
7171
7172 exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
7173 mark = value_mark ();
7174 fetch_watchpoint_value (exp, &val, NULL, NULL);
7175 if (val != NULL)
7176 release_value (val);
7177
7178 tok = arg;
7179 while (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t')
7180 tok++;
7181 end_tok = tok;
7182
7183 while (*end_tok != ' ' && *end_tok != '\t' && *end_tok != '\000')
7184 end_tok++;
7185
7186 toklen = end_tok - tok;
7187 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
7188 {
7189 struct expression *cond;
7190
7191 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
7192 cond = parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0);
7193 xfree (cond);
7194 cond_end = tok;
7195 }
7196 if (*tok)
7197 error (_("Junk at end of command."));
7198
7199 if (accessflag == hw_read)
7200 bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint;
7201 else if (accessflag == hw_access)
7202 bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint;
7203 else
7204 bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
7205
7206 mem_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val);
7207 if (mem_cnt == 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
7208 error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint."));
7209 if (mem_cnt != 0)
7210 {
7211 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count (bp_type, &other_type_used);
7212 target_resources_ok =
7213 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_type, i + mem_cnt,
7214 other_type_used);
7215 if (target_resources_ok == 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
7216 error (_("Target does not support this type of hardware watchpoint."));
7217
7218 if (target_resources_ok < 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
7219 error (_("Target can only support one kind of HW watchpoint at a time."));
7220 }
7221
7222 /* Change the type of breakpoint to an ordinary watchpoint if a hardware
7223 watchpoint could not be set. */
7224 if (!mem_cnt || target_resources_ok <= 0)
7225 bp_type = bp_watchpoint;
7226
7227 frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block);
7228
7229 /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
7230 breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
7231 expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
7232 that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */
7233 if (innermost_block && frame)
7234 {
7235 if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
7236 {
7237 scope_breakpoint
7238 = create_internal_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
7239 frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame),
7240 bp_watchpoint_scope);
7241
7242 scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7243
7244 /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */
7245 scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del;
7246
7247 /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */
7248 scope_breakpoint->frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
7249
7250 /* Set the address at which we will stop. */
7251 scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch
7252 = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
7253 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address
7254 = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
7255 scope_breakpoint->loc->address
7256 = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch,
7257 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address,
7258 scope_breakpoint->type);
7259 }
7260 }
7261
7262 /* Now set up the breakpoint. */
7263 b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (NULL, bp_type);
7264 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
7265 b->number = breakpoint_count;
7266 b->thread = thread;
7267 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
7268 b->exp = exp;
7269 b->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block;
7270 b->exp_string = savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start);
7271 b->val = val;
7272 b->val_valid = 1;
7273 if (cond_start)
7274 b->cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
7275 else
7276 b->cond_string = 0;
7277
7278 if (frame)
7279 {
7280 b->watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (frame);
7281 b->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid;
7282 }
7283 else
7284 {
7285 b->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id;
7286 b->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid;
7287 }
7288
7289 if (scope_breakpoint != NULL)
7290 {
7291 /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will
7292 need to act on them together. */
7293 b->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint;
7294 scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = b;
7295 }
7296
7297 value_free_to_mark (mark);
7298
7299 /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations
7300 that should be inserted. */
7301 update_watchpoint (b, 1);
7302
7303 mention (b);
7304 update_global_location_list (1);
7305 }
7306
7307 /* Return count of locations need to be watched and can be handled
7308 in hardware. If the watchpoint can not be handled
7309 in hardware return zero. */
7310
7311 static int
7312 can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *v)
7313 {
7314 int found_memory_cnt = 0;
7315 struct value *head = v;
7316
7317 /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
7318 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
7319 return 0;
7320
7321 /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
7322 memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we
7323 find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
7324 hardware watchpoint.
7325
7326 The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
7327 of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The
7328 expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
7329 a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
7330 the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
7331 register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate
7332 the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
7333 behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
7334 expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
7335
7336 However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
7337 function calls are special in any way. So this function may not
7338 notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
7339 can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */
7340 for (; v; v = value_next (v))
7341 {
7342 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory)
7343 {
7344 if (value_lazy (v))
7345 /* A lazy memory lvalue is one that GDB never needed to fetch;
7346 we either just used its address (e.g., `a' in `a.b') or
7347 we never needed it at all (e.g., `a' in `a,b'). */
7348 ;
7349 else
7350 {
7351 /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover
7352 it with hardware watchpoints. */
7353 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
7354
7355 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
7356 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
7357 middle of some value chain. */
7358 if (v == head
7359 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
7360 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
7361 {
7362 CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v);
7363 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
7364
7365 if (!target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len))
7366 return 0;
7367 else
7368 found_memory_cnt++;
7369 }
7370 }
7371 }
7372 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval
7373 && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0)
7374 return 0; /* ??? What does this represent? */
7375 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register)
7376 return 0; /* cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint */
7377 }
7378
7379 /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
7380 watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */
7381 return found_memory_cnt;
7382 }
7383
7384 void
7385 watch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
7386 {
7387 watch_command (arg, from_tty);
7388 }
7389
7390 static void
7391 watch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7392 {
7393 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty);
7394 }
7395
7396 void
7397 rwatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
7398 {
7399 rwatch_command (arg, from_tty);
7400 }
7401
7402 static void
7403 rwatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7404 {
7405 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty);
7406 }
7407
7408 void
7409 awatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
7410 {
7411 awatch_command (arg, from_tty);
7412 }
7413
7414 static void
7415 awatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7416 {
7417 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty);
7418 }
7419 \f
7420
7421 /* Helper routines for the until_command routine in infcmd.c. Here
7422 because it uses the mechanisms of breakpoints. */
7423
7424 struct until_break_command_continuation_args
7425 {
7426 struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
7427 struct breakpoint *breakpoint2;
7428 };
7429
7430 /* This function is called by fetch_inferior_event via the
7431 cmd_continuation pointer, to complete the until command. It takes
7432 care of cleaning up the temporary breakpoints set up by the until
7433 command. */
7434 static void
7435 until_break_command_continuation (void *arg)
7436 {
7437 struct until_break_command_continuation_args *a = arg;
7438
7439 delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint);
7440 if (a->breakpoint2)
7441 delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint2);
7442 }
7443
7444 void
7445 until_break_command (char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere)
7446 {
7447 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
7448 struct symtab_and_line sal;
7449 struct frame_info *frame = get_selected_frame (NULL);
7450 struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
7451 struct breakpoint *breakpoint2 = NULL;
7452 struct cleanup *old_chain;
7453
7454 clear_proceed_status ();
7455
7456 /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
7457 this function */
7458
7459 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
7460 sals = decode_line_1 (&arg, 1, default_breakpoint_symtab,
7461 default_breakpoint_line, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
7462 else
7463 sals = decode_line_1 (&arg, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL,
7464 0, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
7465
7466 if (sals.nelts != 1)
7467 error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
7468
7469 sal = sals.sals[0];
7470 xfree (sals.sals); /* malloc'd, so freed */
7471
7472 if (*arg)
7473 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7474
7475 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
7476
7477 if (anywhere)
7478 /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location,
7479 we don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. */
7480 breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (get_frame_arch (frame), sal,
7481 null_frame_id, bp_until);
7482 else
7483 /* Otherwise, specify the selected frame, because we want to stop only
7484 at the very same frame. */
7485 breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (get_frame_arch (frame), sal,
7486 get_stack_frame_id (frame),
7487 bp_until);
7488
7489 old_chain = make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint);
7490
7491 /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
7492 one. */
7493
7494 if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
7495 {
7496 sal = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0);
7497 sal.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
7498 breakpoint2 = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
7499 sal,
7500 frame_unwind_caller_id (frame),
7501 bp_until);
7502 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint2);
7503 }
7504
7505 proceed (-1, TARGET_SIGNAL_DEFAULT, 0);
7506
7507 /* If we are running asynchronously, and proceed call above has actually
7508 managed to start the target, arrange for breakpoints to be
7509 deleted when the target stops. Otherwise, we're already stopped and
7510 delete breakpoints via cleanup chain. */
7511
7512 if (target_can_async_p () && is_running (inferior_ptid))
7513 {
7514 struct until_break_command_continuation_args *args;
7515 args = xmalloc (sizeof (*args));
7516
7517 args->breakpoint = breakpoint;
7518 args->breakpoint2 = breakpoint2;
7519
7520 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
7521 add_continuation (inferior_thread (),
7522 until_break_command_continuation, args,
7523 xfree);
7524 }
7525 else
7526 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7527 }
7528
7529 static void
7530 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (char **s)
7531 {
7532 if ((s == NULL) || (*s == NULL))
7533 return;
7534 while (isspace (**s))
7535 *s += 1;
7536 }
7537
7538 /* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause
7539 from the arg string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
7540
7541 Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string. (It does not
7542 attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.) And,
7543 it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed
7544 if clause in the arg string. */
7545
7546 static char *
7547 ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg)
7548 {
7549 char *cond_string;
7550
7551 if (((*arg)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg)[2]))
7552 return NULL;
7553
7554 /* Skip the "if" keyword. */
7555 (*arg) += 2;
7556
7557 /* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the
7558 condition string. */
7559 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (arg);
7560 cond_string = *arg;
7561
7562 /* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg string. */
7563 (*arg) += strlen (cond_string);
7564
7565 return cond_string;
7566 }
7567
7568 /* This function attempts to parse an optional filename from the arg
7569 string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
7570
7571 Else, it returns a pointer to the parsed filename. (This function
7572 makes no attempt to verify that a file of that name exists, or is
7573 accessible.) And, it updates arg to point to the first character
7574 following the parsed filename in the arg string.
7575
7576 Note that clients needing to preserve the returned filename for
7577 future access should copy it to their own buffers. */
7578 static char *
7579 ep_parse_optional_filename (char **arg)
7580 {
7581 static char filename[1024];
7582 char *arg_p = *arg;
7583 int i;
7584 char c;
7585
7586 if ((*arg_p == '\0') || isspace (*arg_p))
7587 return NULL;
7588
7589 for (i = 0;; i++)
7590 {
7591 c = *arg_p;
7592 if (isspace (c))
7593 c = '\0';
7594 filename[i] = c;
7595 if (c == '\0')
7596 break;
7597 arg_p++;
7598 }
7599 *arg = arg_p;
7600
7601 return filename;
7602 }
7603
7604 /* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions,
7605 process start/exit, etc. */
7606
7607 typedef enum
7608 {
7609 catch_fork_temporary, catch_vfork_temporary,
7610 catch_fork_permanent, catch_vfork_permanent
7611 }
7612 catch_fork_kind;
7613
7614 static void
7615 catch_fork_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7616 {
7617 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7618 char *cond_string = NULL;
7619 catch_fork_kind fork_kind;
7620 int tempflag;
7621
7622 fork_kind = (catch_fork_kind) (uintptr_t) get_cmd_context (command);
7623 tempflag = (fork_kind == catch_fork_temporary
7624 || fork_kind == catch_vfork_temporary);
7625
7626 if (!arg)
7627 arg = "";
7628 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
7629
7630 /* The allowed syntax is:
7631 catch [v]fork
7632 catch [v]fork if <cond>
7633
7634 First, check if there's an if clause. */
7635 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
7636
7637 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
7638 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7639
7640 /* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint
7641 and enable reporting of such events. */
7642 switch (fork_kind)
7643 {
7644 case catch_fork_temporary:
7645 case catch_fork_permanent:
7646 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
7647 &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops);
7648 break;
7649 case catch_vfork_temporary:
7650 case catch_vfork_permanent:
7651 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
7652 &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops);
7653 break;
7654 default:
7655 error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it"));
7656 break;
7657 }
7658 }
7659
7660 static void
7661 catch_exec_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7662 {
7663 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7664 int tempflag;
7665 char *cond_string = NULL;
7666
7667 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7668
7669 if (!arg)
7670 arg = "";
7671 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
7672
7673 /* The allowed syntax is:
7674 catch exec
7675 catch exec if <cond>
7676
7677 First, check if there's an if clause. */
7678 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
7679
7680 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
7681 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7682
7683 /* If this target supports it, create an exec catchpoint
7684 and enable reporting of such events. */
7685 create_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
7686 &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops);
7687 }
7688
7689 static enum print_stop_action
7690 print_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
7691 {
7692 int bp_temp, bp_throw;
7693
7694 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7695
7696 bp_throw = strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL;
7697 if (b->loc->address != b->loc->requested_address)
7698 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (b->loc->requested_address,
7699 b->loc->address,
7700 b->number, 1);
7701 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
7702 ui_out_text (uiout,
7703 bp_temp ? "Temporary catchpoint "
7704 : "Catchpoint ");
7705 if (!ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7706 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
7707 ui_out_text (uiout,
7708 bp_throw ? " (exception thrown), "
7709 : " (exception caught), ");
7710 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7711 {
7712 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
7713 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
7714 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7715 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
7716 }
7717 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7718 }
7719
7720 static void
7721 print_one_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7722 {
7723 struct value_print_options opts;
7724 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7725 if (opts.addressprint)
7726 {
7727 annotate_field (4);
7728 if (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->shlib_disabled)
7729 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
7730 else
7731 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
7732 b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address);
7733 }
7734 annotate_field (5);
7735 if (b->loc)
7736 *last_loc = b->loc;
7737 if (strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL)
7738 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "exception throw");
7739 else
7740 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "exception catch");
7741 }
7742
7743 static void
7744 print_mention_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
7745 {
7746 int bp_temp;
7747 int bp_throw;
7748
7749 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
7750 bp_throw = strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL;
7751 ui_out_text (uiout, bp_temp ? _("Temporary catchpoint ")
7752 : _("Catchpoint "));
7753 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
7754 ui_out_text (uiout, bp_throw ? _(" (throw)")
7755 : _(" (catch)"));
7756 }
7757
7758 static struct breakpoint_ops gnu_v3_exception_catchpoint_ops = {
7759 NULL, /* insert */
7760 NULL, /* remove */
7761 NULL, /* breakpoint_hit */
7762 print_exception_catchpoint,
7763 print_one_exception_catchpoint,
7764 print_mention_exception_catchpoint
7765 };
7766
7767 static int
7768 handle_gnu_v3_exceptions (int tempflag, char *cond_string,
7769 enum exception_event_kind ex_event, int from_tty)
7770 {
7771 char *trigger_func_name;
7772
7773 if (ex_event == EX_EVENT_CATCH)
7774 trigger_func_name = "__cxa_begin_catch";
7775 else
7776 trigger_func_name = "__cxa_throw";
7777
7778 break_command_really (get_current_arch (),
7779 trigger_func_name, cond_string, -1,
7780 0 /* condition and thread are valid. */,
7781 tempflag, 0, 0,
7782 0,
7783 AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE /* pending */,
7784 &gnu_v3_exception_catchpoint_ops, from_tty,
7785 1 /* enabled */);
7786
7787 return 1;
7788 }
7789
7790 /* Deal with "catch catch" and "catch throw" commands */
7791
7792 static void
7793 catch_exception_command_1 (enum exception_event_kind ex_event, char *arg,
7794 int tempflag, int from_tty)
7795 {
7796 char *cond_string = NULL;
7797 struct symtab_and_line *sal = NULL;
7798
7799 if (!arg)
7800 arg = "";
7801 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
7802
7803 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
7804
7805 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
7806 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7807
7808 if (ex_event != EX_EVENT_THROW
7809 && ex_event != EX_EVENT_CATCH)
7810 error (_("Unsupported or unknown exception event; cannot catch it"));
7811
7812 if (handle_gnu_v3_exceptions (tempflag, cond_string, ex_event, from_tty))
7813 return;
7814
7815 warning (_("Unsupported with this platform/compiler combination."));
7816 }
7817
7818 /* Implementation of "catch catch" command. */
7819
7820 static void
7821 catch_catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7822 {
7823 int tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7824 catch_exception_command_1 (EX_EVENT_CATCH, arg, tempflag, from_tty);
7825 }
7826
7827 /* Implementation of "catch throw" command. */
7828
7829 static void
7830 catch_throw_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7831 {
7832 int tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7833 catch_exception_command_1 (EX_EVENT_THROW, arg, tempflag, from_tty);
7834 }
7835
7836 /* Create a breakpoint struct for Ada exception catchpoints. */
7837
7838 static void
7839 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7840 struct symtab_and_line sal,
7841 char *addr_string,
7842 char *exp_string,
7843 char *cond_string,
7844 struct expression *cond,
7845 struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
7846 int tempflag,
7847 int from_tty)
7848 {
7849 struct breakpoint *b;
7850
7851 if (from_tty)
7852 {
7853 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
7854 if (!loc_gdbarch)
7855 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
7856
7857 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
7858 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1);
7859 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
7860 version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
7861 used for different exception names will use the same address.
7862 In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
7863 unproductive. Besides. the warning phrasing is also a bit
7864 inapropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
7865 the user what type of catchpoint it is. The above is good
7866 enough for now, though. */
7867 }
7868
7869 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, bp_breakpoint);
7870 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
7871
7872 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7873 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
7874 b->number = breakpoint_count;
7875 b->ignore_count = 0;
7876 b->loc->cond = cond;
7877 b->addr_string = addr_string;
7878 b->language = language_ada;
7879 b->cond_string = cond_string;
7880 b->exp_string = exp_string;
7881 b->thread = -1;
7882 b->ops = ops;
7883
7884 mention (b);
7885 update_global_location_list (1);
7886 }
7887
7888 /* Implement the "catch exception" command. */
7889
7890 static void
7891 catch_ada_exception_command (char *arg, int from_tty,
7892 struct cmd_list_element *command)
7893 {
7894 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7895 int tempflag;
7896 struct symtab_and_line sal;
7897 enum bptype type;
7898 char *addr_string = NULL;
7899 char *exp_string = NULL;
7900 char *cond_string = NULL;
7901 struct expression *cond = NULL;
7902 struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
7903
7904 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7905
7906 if (!arg)
7907 arg = "";
7908 sal = ada_decode_exception_location (arg, &addr_string, &exp_string,
7909 &cond_string, &cond, &ops);
7910 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, addr_string, exp_string,
7911 cond_string, cond, ops, tempflag,
7912 from_tty);
7913 }
7914
7915 /* Cleanup function for a syscall filter list. */
7916 static void
7917 clean_up_filters (void *arg)
7918 {
7919 VEC(int) *iter = *(VEC(int) **) arg;
7920 VEC_free (int, iter);
7921 }
7922
7923 /* Splits the argument using space as delimiter. Returns an xmalloc'd
7924 filter list, or NULL if no filtering is required. */
7925 static VEC(int) *
7926 catch_syscall_split_args (char *arg)
7927 {
7928 VEC(int) *result = NULL;
7929 struct cleanup *cleanup = make_cleanup (clean_up_filters, &result);
7930
7931 while (*arg != '\0')
7932 {
7933 int i, syscall_number;
7934 char *endptr;
7935 char cur_name[128];
7936 struct syscall s;
7937
7938 /* Skip whitespace. */
7939 while (isspace (*arg))
7940 arg++;
7941
7942 for (i = 0; i < 127 && arg[i] && !isspace (arg[i]); ++i)
7943 cur_name[i] = arg[i];
7944 cur_name[i] = '\0';
7945 arg += i;
7946
7947 /* Check if the user provided a syscall name or a number. */
7948 syscall_number = (int) strtol (cur_name, &endptr, 0);
7949 if (*endptr == '\0')
7950 get_syscall_by_number (syscall_number, &s);
7951 else
7952 {
7953 /* We have a name. Let's check if it's valid and convert it
7954 to a number. */
7955 get_syscall_by_name (cur_name, &s);
7956
7957 if (s.number == UNKNOWN_SYSCALL)
7958 /* Here we have to issue an error instead of a warning, because
7959 GDB cannot do anything useful if there's no syscall number to
7960 be caught. */
7961 error (_("Unknown syscall name '%s'."), cur_name);
7962 }
7963
7964 /* Ok, it's valid. */
7965 VEC_safe_push (int, result, s.number);
7966 }
7967
7968 discard_cleanups (cleanup);
7969 return result;
7970 }
7971
7972 /* Implement the "catch syscall" command. */
7973
7974 static void
7975 catch_syscall_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7976 {
7977 int tempflag;
7978 VEC(int) *filter;
7979 struct syscall s;
7980 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7981
7982 /* Checking if the feature if supported. */
7983 if (gdbarch_get_syscall_number_p (gdbarch) == 0)
7984 error (_("The feature 'catch syscall' is not supported on \
7985 this architeture yet."));
7986
7987 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7988
7989 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
7990
7991 /* We need to do this first "dummy" translation in order
7992 to get the syscall XML file loaded or, most important,
7993 to display a warning to the user if there's no XML file
7994 for his/her architecture. */
7995 get_syscall_by_number (0, &s);
7996
7997 /* The allowed syntax is:
7998 catch syscall
7999 catch syscall <name | number> [<name | number> ... <name | number>]
8000
8001 Let's check if there's a syscall name. */
8002
8003 if (arg != NULL)
8004 filter = catch_syscall_split_args (arg);
8005 else
8006 filter = NULL;
8007
8008 create_syscall_event_catchpoint (tempflag, filter,
8009 &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops);
8010 }
8011
8012 /* Implement the "catch assert" command. */
8013
8014 static void
8015 catch_assert_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
8016 {
8017 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8018 int tempflag;
8019 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8020 char *addr_string = NULL;
8021 struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
8022
8023 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8024
8025 if (!arg)
8026 arg = "";
8027 sal = ada_decode_assert_location (arg, &addr_string, &ops);
8028 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, addr_string, NULL, NULL, NULL,
8029 ops, tempflag, from_tty);
8030 }
8031
8032 static void
8033 catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8034 {
8035 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
8036 }
8037 \f
8038
8039 static void
8040 tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8041 {
8042 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
8043 }
8044
8045 /* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */
8046
8047 static void
8048 clear_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8049 {
8050 struct breakpoint *b;
8051 VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
8052 int ix;
8053 int default_match;
8054 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
8055 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8056 int i;
8057
8058 if (arg)
8059 {
8060 sals = decode_line_spec (arg, 1);
8061 default_match = 0;
8062 }
8063 else
8064 {
8065 sals.sals = (struct symtab_and_line *)
8066 xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
8067 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
8068 init_sal (&sal); /* initialize to zeroes */
8069 sal.line = default_breakpoint_line;
8070 sal.symtab = default_breakpoint_symtab;
8071 sal.pc = default_breakpoint_address;
8072 sal.pspace = default_breakpoint_pspace;
8073 if (sal.symtab == 0)
8074 error (_("No source file specified."));
8075
8076 sals.sals[0] = sal;
8077 sals.nelts = 1;
8078
8079 default_match = 1;
8080 }
8081
8082 /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not
8083 as bad as it seems, because all existing breakpoints
8084 typically have both file/line and pc set. So, if
8085 clear is given file/line, we can match this to existing
8086 breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
8087
8088 We only support clearing given the address explicitly
8089 present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint
8090 at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
8091 due to optimization, all in one block.
8092 We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
8093 PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
8094 be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
8095 since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
8096 can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
8097 to support that. */
8098
8099 /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond
8100 to it. Do it in two passes, solely to preserve the current
8101 behavior that from_tty is forced true if we delete more than
8102 one breakpoint. */
8103
8104 found = NULL;
8105 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
8106 {
8107 /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
8108 If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
8109 If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
8110 or at default pc.
8111
8112 defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do
8113
8114 0 1 pc
8115 1 1 pc _and_ line
8116 0 0 line
8117 1 0 <can't happen> */
8118
8119 sal = sals.sals[i];
8120
8121 /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to
8122 'found'. */
8123 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8124 {
8125 int match = 0;
8126 /* Are we going to delete b? */
8127 if (b->type != bp_none
8128 && b->type != bp_watchpoint
8129 && b->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
8130 && b->type != bp_read_watchpoint
8131 && b->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
8132 {
8133 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
8134 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
8135 {
8136 int pc_match = sal.pc
8137 && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace)
8138 && (loc->address == sal.pc)
8139 && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section)
8140 || loc->section == sal.section);
8141 int line_match = ((default_match || (0 == sal.pc))
8142 && b->source_file != NULL
8143 && sal.symtab != NULL
8144 && sal.pspace == loc->pspace
8145 && strcmp (b->source_file, sal.symtab->filename) == 0
8146 && b->line_number == sal.line);
8147 if (pc_match || line_match)
8148 {
8149 match = 1;
8150 break;
8151 }
8152 }
8153 }
8154
8155 if (match)
8156 VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
8157 }
8158 }
8159 /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */
8160 if (VEC_empty(breakpoint_p, found))
8161 {
8162 if (arg)
8163 error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg);
8164 else
8165 error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
8166 }
8167
8168 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) > 1)
8169 from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one */
8170 if (from_tty)
8171 {
8172 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) == 1)
8173 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
8174 else
8175 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
8176 }
8177 breakpoints_changed ();
8178
8179 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate(breakpoint_p, found, ix, b); ix++)
8180 {
8181 if (from_tty)
8182 printf_unfiltered ("%d ", b->number);
8183 delete_breakpoint (b);
8184 }
8185 if (from_tty)
8186 putchar_unfiltered ('\n');
8187 }
8188 \f
8189 /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
8190 all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
8191 This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */
8192
8193 void
8194 breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs)
8195 {
8196 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
8197
8198 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
8199 if (bs->breakpoint_at
8200 && bs->breakpoint_at->owner
8201 && bs->breakpoint_at->owner->disposition == disp_del
8202 && bs->stop)
8203 delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner);
8204
8205 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
8206 {
8207 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
8208 delete_breakpoint (b);
8209 }
8210 }
8211
8212 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to qsort.
8213 Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what does
8214 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful say for its OWNER), secondarily by ordering
8215 first bp_permanent OWNERed elements and terciarily just ensuring the array
8216 is sorted stable way despite qsort being an instable algorithm. */
8217
8218 static int
8219 bp_location_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
8220 {
8221 struct bp_location *a = *(void **) ap;
8222 struct bp_location *b = *(void **) bp;
8223 int a_perm = a->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent;
8224 int b_perm = b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent;
8225
8226 if (a->address != b->address)
8227 return (a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address);
8228
8229 /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */
8230 if (a_perm != b_perm)
8231 return (a_perm < b_perm) - (a_perm > b_perm);
8232
8233 /* Make the user-visible order stable across GDB runs. Locations of the same
8234 breakpoint can be sorted in arbitrary order. */
8235
8236 if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number)
8237 return (a->owner->number > b->owner->number)
8238 - (a->owner->number < b->owner->number);
8239
8240 return (a > b) - (a < b);
8241 }
8242
8243 /* Set bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max and
8244 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current content of
8245 the bp_location array. */
8246
8247 static void
8248 bp_location_target_extensions_update (void)
8249 {
8250 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
8251
8252 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = 0;
8253 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0;
8254
8255 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
8256 {
8257 CORE_ADDR start, end, addr;
8258
8259 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
8260 continue;
8261
8262 start = bl->target_info.placed_address;
8263 end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len;
8264
8265 gdb_assert (bl->address >= start);
8266 addr = bl->address - start;
8267 if (addr > bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
8268 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = addr;
8269
8270 /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */
8271
8272 gdb_assert (bl->address < end);
8273 addr = end - bl->address;
8274 if (addr > bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max)
8275 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr;
8276 }
8277 }
8278
8279 /* If SHOULD_INSERT is false, do not insert any breakpoint locations
8280 into the inferior, only remove already-inserted locations that no
8281 longer should be inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or
8282 breakpoints should pass false, so that deleting a breakpoint
8283 doesn't have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
8284 breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
8285 returns true on them.
8286
8287 This behaviour is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
8288 after an exec, while the target still has execution, but breakpoint
8289 shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT* be restored
8290 to the new image; or before detaching, where the target still has
8291 execution and wants to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists, and all
8292 breakpoints had already been removed from the inferior. */
8293
8294 static void
8295 update_global_location_list (int should_insert)
8296 {
8297 struct breakpoint *b;
8298 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
8299 struct cleanup *cleanups;
8300
8301 /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all
8302 bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
8303 Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
8304 duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of
8305 breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
8306 once. */
8307 struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */
8308 struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */
8309 struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */
8310 struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */
8311
8312 /* Saved former bp_location array which we compare against the newly built
8313 bp_location from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */
8314 struct bp_location **old_location, **old_locp;
8315 unsigned old_location_count;
8316
8317 old_location = bp_location;
8318 old_location_count = bp_location_count;
8319 bp_location = NULL;
8320 bp_location_count = 0;
8321 cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, old_location);
8322
8323 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8324 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
8325 bp_location_count++;
8326
8327 bp_location = xmalloc (sizeof (*bp_location) * bp_location_count);
8328 locp = bp_location;
8329 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8330 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
8331 *locp++ = loc;
8332 qsort (bp_location, bp_location_count, sizeof (*bp_location),
8333 bp_location_compare);
8334
8335 bp_location_target_extensions_update ();
8336
8337 /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the new
8338 list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not necessary that
8339 those locations should be removed from inferior -- if there's another
8340 location at the same address (previously marked as duplicate),
8341 we don't need to remove/insert the location.
8342
8343 LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current and
8344 former bp_location array state respectively. */
8345
8346 locp = bp_location;
8347 for (old_locp = old_location; old_locp < old_location + old_location_count;
8348 old_locp++)
8349 {
8350 struct bp_location *old_loc = *old_locp;
8351 struct bp_location **loc2p;
8352
8353 /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found amoung the new locations. If not, we
8354 have to free it. */
8355 int found_object = 0;
8356 /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */
8357 int keep_in_target = 0;
8358 int removed = 0;
8359
8360 /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed. Stop either
8361 at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */
8362 while (locp < bp_location + bp_location_count
8363 && (*locp)->address < old_loc->address)
8364 locp++;
8365
8366 for (loc2p = locp;
8367 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
8368 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
8369 loc2p++)
8370 {
8371 if (*loc2p == old_loc)
8372 {
8373 found_object = 1;
8374 break;
8375 }
8376 }
8377
8378 /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if there's
8379 maybe a new location at the same address. If so, mark that one
8380 inserted, and don't remove this one. This is needed so that we
8381 don't have a time window where a breakpoint at certain location is not
8382 inserted. */
8383
8384 if (old_loc->inserted)
8385 {
8386 /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove it. */
8387
8388 if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc))
8389 {
8390 /* The location is still present in the location list, and still
8391 should be inserted. Don't do anything. */
8392 keep_in_target = 1;
8393 }
8394 else
8395 {
8396 /* The location is either no longer present, or got disabled.
8397 See if there's another location at the same address, in which
8398 case we don't need to remove this one from the target. */
8399
8400 if (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner))
8401 {
8402 for (loc2p = locp;
8403 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
8404 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
8405 loc2p++)
8406 {
8407 struct bp_location *loc2 = *loc2p;
8408
8409 if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc))
8410 {
8411 /* For the sake of should_be_inserted.
8412 Duplicates check below will fix up this later. */
8413 loc2->duplicate = 0;
8414 if (loc2 != old_loc && should_be_inserted (loc2))
8415 {
8416 loc2->inserted = 1;
8417 loc2->target_info = old_loc->target_info;
8418 keep_in_target = 1;
8419 break;
8420 }
8421 }
8422 }
8423 }
8424 }
8425
8426 if (!keep_in_target)
8427 {
8428 if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc, mark_uninserted))
8429 {
8430 /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep this
8431 location on the global list, and try to remove it next
8432 time, but there's no particular reason why we will
8433 succeed next time.
8434
8435 Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still valid,
8436 as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint only
8437 after calling us. */
8438 printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing breakpoint %d\n"),
8439 old_loc->owner->number);
8440 }
8441 removed = 1;
8442 }
8443 }
8444
8445 if (!found_object)
8446 {
8447 if (removed && non_stop
8448 && breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner)
8449 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
8450 {
8451 /* This location was removed from the target. In
8452 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
8453 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
8454 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
8455 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
8456 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
8457 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
8458 after we see some number of events. The theory here
8459 is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
8460 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
8461 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
8462 need to keep this breakpoint location around. We
8463 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
8464 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
8465 SIGTRAP.
8466
8467 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
8468 decr_pc_after_break targets.
8469
8470 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
8471 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
8472 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
8473 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
8474 a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes
8475 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
8476 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SEGSEGV, or worse, get silently
8477 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
8478 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
8479 one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen
8480 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
8481 targets that do not support new thread events, like
8482 remote, due to the heuristic depending on
8483 thread_count.
8484
8485 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
8486 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
8487 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
8488 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
8489
8490 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
8491 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
8492 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
8493 around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
8494 traps we can no longer explain. */
8495
8496 old_loc->events_till_retirement = 3 * (thread_count () + 1);
8497 old_loc->owner = NULL;
8498
8499 VEC_safe_push (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, old_loc);
8500 }
8501 else
8502 free_bp_location (old_loc);
8503 }
8504 }
8505
8506 /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
8507 first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so
8508 that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a
8509 permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
8510 official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints
8511 are sorted first for the same address.
8512
8513 Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
8514 watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */
8515
8516 bp_loc_first = NULL;
8517 wp_loc_first = NULL;
8518 awp_loc_first = NULL;
8519 rwp_loc_first = NULL;
8520 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
8521 {
8522 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
8523 struct bp_location **loc_first_p;
8524
8525 if (b->enable_state == bp_disabled
8526 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled
8527 || b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled
8528 || !loc->enabled
8529 || loc->shlib_disabled
8530 || !breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (b))
8531 continue;
8532
8533 /* Permanent breakpoint should always be inserted. */
8534 if (b->enable_state == bp_permanent && ! loc->inserted)
8535 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
8536 _("allegedly permanent breakpoint is not "
8537 "actually inserted"));
8538
8539 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
8540 loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first;
8541 else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
8542 loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first;
8543 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
8544 loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first;
8545 else
8546 loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first;
8547
8548 if (*loc_first_p == NULL
8549 || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section)
8550 || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p))
8551 {
8552 *loc_first_p = loc;
8553 loc->duplicate = 0;
8554 continue;
8555 }
8556
8557 loc->duplicate = 1;
8558
8559 if ((*loc_first_p)->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent && loc->inserted
8560 && b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
8561 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
8562 _("another breakpoint was inserted on top of "
8563 "a permanent breakpoint"));
8564 }
8565
8566 if (breakpoints_always_inserted_mode () && should_insert
8567 && (have_live_inferiors ()
8568 || (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch))))
8569 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
8570
8571 do_cleanups (cleanups);
8572 }
8573
8574 void
8575 breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
8576 {
8577 struct bp_location *loc;
8578 int ix;
8579
8580 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
8581 if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0)
8582 {
8583 free_bp_location (loc);
8584 VEC_unordered_remove (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix);
8585 --ix;
8586 }
8587 }
8588
8589 static void
8590 update_global_location_list_nothrow (int inserting)
8591 {
8592 struct gdb_exception e;
8593 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
8594 update_global_location_list (inserting);
8595 }
8596
8597 /* Clear BPT from a BPS. */
8598 static void
8599 bpstat_remove_breakpoint (bpstat bps, struct breakpoint *bpt)
8600 {
8601 bpstat bs;
8602 for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next)
8603 if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->owner == bpt)
8604 {
8605 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
8606 bs->old_val = NULL;
8607 /* bs->commands will be freed later. */
8608 }
8609 }
8610
8611 /* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */
8612 static int
8613 bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data)
8614 {
8615 struct breakpoint *bpt = data;
8616 bpstat_remove_breakpoint (th->stop_bpstat, bpt);
8617 return 0;
8618 }
8619
8620 /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
8621 structures. */
8622
8623 void
8624 delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
8625 {
8626 struct breakpoint *b;
8627 struct bp_location *loc, *next;
8628
8629 gdb_assert (bpt != NULL);
8630
8631 /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because multiple
8632 lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are especial culprits.
8633
8634 One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When the
8635 scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of scope, and
8636 delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the scope bp is marked
8637 "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat. That bpstat is then
8638 checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are deleted.
8639
8640 A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in bp's,
8641 and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing bpstat's, and
8642 teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's storage when no more
8643 references were extent. A cheaper bandaid was chosen. */
8644 if (bpt->type == bp_none)
8645 return;
8646
8647 observer_notify_breakpoint_deleted (bpt->number);
8648
8649 if (breakpoint_chain == bpt)
8650 breakpoint_chain = bpt->next;
8651
8652 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8653 if (b->next == bpt)
8654 {
8655 b->next = bpt->next;
8656 break;
8657 }
8658
8659 free_command_lines (&bpt->commands);
8660 if (bpt->cond_string != NULL)
8661 xfree (bpt->cond_string);
8662 if (bpt->addr_string != NULL)
8663 xfree (bpt->addr_string);
8664 if (bpt->exp != NULL)
8665 xfree (bpt->exp);
8666 if (bpt->exp_string != NULL)
8667 xfree (bpt->exp_string);
8668 if (bpt->val != NULL)
8669 value_free (bpt->val);
8670 if (bpt->source_file != NULL)
8671 xfree (bpt->source_file);
8672 if (bpt->exec_pathname != NULL)
8673 xfree (bpt->exec_pathname);
8674 clean_up_filters (&bpt->syscalls_to_be_caught);
8675
8676 /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at it after it's been freed. */
8677 /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's?
8678 We just check stop_bpstat for now. Note that we cannot just
8679 remove bpstats pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list
8680 entirely, as breakpoint commands are associated with the bpstat;
8681 if we remove it here, then the later call to
8682 bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat);
8683 in event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints
8684 with commands won't work. */
8685
8686 iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt);
8687
8688 /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint
8689 list, update the global location list. This
8690 will remove locations that used to belong to
8691 this breakpoint. Do this before freeing
8692 the breakpoint itself, since remove_breakpoint
8693 looks at location's owner. It might be better
8694 design to have location completely self-contained,
8695 but it's not the case now. */
8696 update_global_location_list (0);
8697
8698
8699 /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this same
8700 bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
8701 bpt->type = bp_none;
8702
8703 xfree (bpt);
8704 }
8705
8706 static void
8707 do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup (void *b)
8708 {
8709 delete_breakpoint (b);
8710 }
8711
8712 struct cleanup *
8713 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
8714 {
8715 return make_cleanup (do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup, b);
8716 }
8717
8718 void
8719 delete_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8720 {
8721 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
8722
8723 dont_repeat ();
8724
8725 if (arg == 0)
8726 {
8727 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
8728
8729 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
8730 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
8731 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number argument. */
8732 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8733 {
8734 if (b->type != bp_call_dummy
8735 && b->type != bp_shlib_event
8736 && b->type != bp_jit_event
8737 && b->type != bp_thread_event
8738 && b->type != bp_overlay_event
8739 && b->type != bp_longjmp_master
8740 && b->number >= 0)
8741 {
8742 breaks_to_delete = 1;
8743 break;
8744 }
8745 }
8746
8747 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
8748 if (!from_tty
8749 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
8750 {
8751 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
8752 {
8753 if (b->type != bp_call_dummy
8754 && b->type != bp_shlib_event
8755 && b->type != bp_thread_event
8756 && b->type != bp_jit_event
8757 && b->type != bp_overlay_event
8758 && b->type != bp_longjmp_master
8759 && b->number >= 0)
8760 delete_breakpoint (b);
8761 }
8762 }
8763 }
8764 else
8765 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, delete_breakpoint);
8766 }
8767
8768 static int
8769 all_locations_are_pending (struct bp_location *loc)
8770 {
8771 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
8772 if (!loc->shlib_disabled)
8773 return 0;
8774 return 1;
8775 }
8776
8777 /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
8778 Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
8779 Null names are ignored. */
8780
8781 static int
8782 ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc)
8783 {
8784 struct bp_location *l;
8785 htab_t htab = htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string,
8786 (int (*) (const void *, const void *)) streq,
8787 NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
8788
8789 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next)
8790 {
8791 const char **slot;
8792 const char *name = l->function_name;
8793
8794 /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */
8795 if (name == NULL)
8796 continue;
8797
8798 slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab, (const void *) name,
8799 INSERT);
8800 /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never returns
8801 NULL. */
8802 if (*slot != NULL)
8803 {
8804 htab_delete (htab);
8805 return 1;
8806 }
8807 *slot = name;
8808 }
8809
8810 htab_delete (htab);
8811 return 0;
8812 }
8813
8814 static void
8815 update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b,
8816 struct symtabs_and_lines sals)
8817 {
8818 int i;
8819 char *s;
8820 struct bp_location *existing_locations = b->loc;
8821
8822 /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations
8823 are pending, don't do anything. This optimizes
8824 the common case where all locations are in the same
8825 shared library, that was unloaded. We'd like to
8826 retain the location, so that when the library
8827 is loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled
8828 status of the individual locations. */
8829 if (all_locations_are_pending (existing_locations) && sals.nelts == 0)
8830 return;
8831
8832 b->loc = NULL;
8833
8834 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
8835 {
8836 struct bp_location *new_loc =
8837 add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &(sals.sals[i]));
8838
8839 /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
8840 old symtab. */
8841 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
8842 {
8843 struct gdb_exception e;
8844
8845 s = b->cond_string;
8846 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
8847 {
8848 new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, block_for_pc (sals.sals[i].pc),
8849 0);
8850 }
8851 if (e.reason < 0)
8852 {
8853 warning (_("failed to reevaluate condition for breakpoint %d: %s"),
8854 b->number, e.message);
8855 new_loc->enabled = 0;
8856 }
8857 }
8858
8859 if (b->source_file != NULL)
8860 xfree (b->source_file);
8861 if (sals.sals[i].symtab == NULL)
8862 b->source_file = NULL;
8863 else
8864 b->source_file = xstrdup (sals.sals[i].symtab->filename);
8865
8866 if (b->line_number == 0)
8867 b->line_number = sals.sals[i].line;
8868 }
8869
8870 /* Update locations of permanent breakpoints. */
8871 if (b->enable_state == bp_permanent)
8872 make_breakpoint_permanent (b);
8873
8874 /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing breakpoints. */
8875 {
8876 struct bp_location *e = existing_locations;
8877 /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
8878 e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
8879 Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
8880 may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
8881 often enough until a better solution is found. */
8882 int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc);
8883
8884 for (; e; e = e->next)
8885 {
8886 if (!e->enabled && e->function_name)
8887 {
8888 struct bp_location *l = b->loc;
8889 if (have_ambiguous_names)
8890 {
8891 for (; l; l = l->next)
8892 if (breakpoint_address_match (e->pspace->aspace, e->address,
8893 l->pspace->aspace, l->address))
8894 {
8895 l->enabled = 0;
8896 break;
8897 }
8898 }
8899 else
8900 {
8901 for (; l; l = l->next)
8902 if (l->function_name
8903 && strcmp (e->function_name, l->function_name) == 0)
8904 {
8905 l->enabled = 0;
8906 break;
8907 }
8908 }
8909 }
8910 }
8911 }
8912
8913 update_global_location_list (1);
8914 }
8915
8916
8917 /* Reset a breakpoint given it's struct breakpoint * BINT.
8918 The value we return ends up being the return value from catch_errors.
8919 Unused in this case. */
8920
8921 static int
8922 breakpoint_re_set_one (void *bint)
8923 {
8924 /* get past catch_errs */
8925 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) bint;
8926 struct value *mark;
8927 int i;
8928 int not_found = 0;
8929 int *not_found_ptr = &not_found;
8930 struct symtabs_and_lines sals = {0};
8931 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded = {0};
8932 char *s;
8933 enum enable_state save_enable;
8934 struct gdb_exception e;
8935 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
8936
8937 switch (b->type)
8938 {
8939 case bp_none:
8940 warning (_("attempted to reset apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
8941 b->number);
8942 return 0;
8943 case bp_breakpoint:
8944 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
8945 case bp_tracepoint:
8946 /* Do not attempt to re-set breakpoints disabled during startup. */
8947 if (b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
8948 return 0;
8949
8950 if (b->addr_string == NULL)
8951 {
8952 /* Anything without a string can't be re-set. */
8953 delete_breakpoint (b);
8954 return 0;
8955 }
8956
8957 set_language (b->language);
8958 input_radix = b->input_radix;
8959 s = b->addr_string;
8960
8961 save_current_space_and_thread ();
8962 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
8963
8964 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
8965 {
8966 sals = decode_line_1 (&s, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0, (char ***) NULL,
8967 not_found_ptr);
8968 }
8969 if (e.reason < 0)
8970 {
8971 int not_found_and_ok = 0;
8972 /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing
8973 will fail until the right shared library is loaded.
8974 User has already told to create pending breakpoints and
8975 don't need extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
8976 state, then user already saw the message about that breakpoint
8977 being disabled, and don't want to see more errors. */
8978 if (not_found
8979 && (b->condition_not_parsed
8980 || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled)
8981 || b->enable_state == bp_disabled))
8982 not_found_and_ok = 1;
8983
8984 if (!not_found_and_ok)
8985 {
8986 /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
8987 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable
8988 the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to
8989 have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this
8990 happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
8991 which approach is better. */
8992 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
8993 throw_exception (e);
8994 }
8995 }
8996
8997 if (!not_found)
8998 {
8999 gdb_assert (sals.nelts == 1);
9000
9001 resolve_sal_pc (&sals.sals[0]);
9002 if (b->condition_not_parsed && s && s[0])
9003 {
9004 char *cond_string = 0;
9005 int thread = -1;
9006 int task = 0;
9007
9008 find_condition_and_thread (s, sals.sals[0].pc,
9009 &cond_string, &thread, &task);
9010 if (cond_string)
9011 b->cond_string = cond_string;
9012 b->thread = thread;
9013 b->task = task;
9014 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
9015 }
9016
9017 expanded = expand_line_sal_maybe (sals.sals[0]);
9018 }
9019
9020 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
9021 update_breakpoint_locations (b, expanded);
9022 break;
9023
9024 case bp_watchpoint:
9025 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9026 case bp_read_watchpoint:
9027 case bp_access_watchpoint:
9028 /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global variables,
9029 or it can be on local variables.
9030
9031 Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even persist
9032 across program restarts. Since they can use variables from shared
9033 libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries are loaded
9034 and unloaded.
9035
9036 Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result
9037 of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local and
9038 a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint, but
9039 unloading of a shared library will make the expression invalid.
9040 This is not a very common use case, but we still re-evaluate
9041 expression, to avoid surprises to the user.
9042
9043 Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
9044 watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means
9045 the watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact,
9046 I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
9047
9048 If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
9049 b->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
9050
9051 Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will
9052 be reevaluated again when enabled. */
9053 update_watchpoint (b, 1 /* reparse */);
9054 break;
9055 /* We needn't really do anything to reset these, since the mask
9056 that requests them is unaffected by e.g., new libraries being
9057 loaded. */
9058 case bp_catchpoint:
9059 break;
9060
9061 default:
9062 printf_filtered (_("Deleting unknown breakpoint type %d\n"), b->type);
9063 /* fall through */
9064 /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they will be
9065 reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */
9066 case bp_overlay_event:
9067 case bp_longjmp_master:
9068 delete_breakpoint (b);
9069 break;
9070
9071 /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
9072 starts and we really don't want to touch it. */
9073 case bp_shlib_event:
9074
9075 /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special.
9076 Once it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */
9077 case bp_thread_event:
9078
9079 /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step
9080 over a dlopen call and SOLIB_ADD is resetting the breakpoints.
9081 Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain
9082 or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable. */
9083 case bp_until:
9084 case bp_finish:
9085 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
9086 case bp_call_dummy:
9087 case bp_step_resume:
9088 case bp_longjmp:
9089 case bp_longjmp_resume:
9090 case bp_jit_event:
9091 break;
9092 }
9093
9094 do_cleanups (cleanups);
9095 return 0;
9096 }
9097
9098 /* Re-set all breakpoints after symbols have been re-loaded. */
9099 void
9100 breakpoint_re_set (void)
9101 {
9102 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
9103 enum language save_language;
9104 int save_input_radix;
9105 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9106
9107 save_language = current_language->la_language;
9108 save_input_radix = input_radix;
9109 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
9110
9111 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
9112 {
9113 /* Format possible error msg */
9114 char *message = xstrprintf ("Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
9115 b->number);
9116 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
9117 catch_errors (breakpoint_re_set_one, b, message, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
9118 do_cleanups (cleanups);
9119 }
9120 set_language (save_language);
9121 input_radix = save_input_radix;
9122
9123 jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
9124
9125 do_cleanups (old_chain);
9126
9127 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ("_ovly_debug_event");
9128 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("longjmp");
9129 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_longjmp");
9130 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("siglongjmp");
9131 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_siglongjmp");
9132 }
9133 \f
9134 /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
9135
9136 - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
9137 - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
9138 void
9139 breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b)
9140 {
9141 if (b->thread != -1)
9142 {
9143 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
9144 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
9145
9146 /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is
9147 selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
9148 different program space from the original thread. Reset that
9149 as well. */
9150 b->loc->pspace = current_program_space;
9151 }
9152 }
9153
9154 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
9155 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
9156 which ends with a period (no newline). */
9157
9158 void
9159 set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty)
9160 {
9161 struct breakpoint *b;
9162
9163 if (count < 0)
9164 count = 0;
9165
9166 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9167 if (b->number == bptnum)
9168 {
9169 b->ignore_count = count;
9170 if (from_tty)
9171 {
9172 if (count == 0)
9173 printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time breakpoint %d is reached."),
9174 bptnum);
9175 else if (count == 1)
9176 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
9177 bptnum);
9178 else
9179 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d crossings of breakpoint %d."),
9180 count, bptnum);
9181 }
9182 breakpoints_changed ();
9183 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
9184 return;
9185 }
9186
9187 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum);
9188 }
9189
9190 void
9191 make_breakpoint_silent (struct breakpoint *b)
9192 {
9193 /* Silence the breakpoint. */
9194 b->silent = 1;
9195 }
9196
9197 /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */
9198
9199 static void
9200 ignore_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9201 {
9202 char *p = args;
9203 int num;
9204
9205 if (p == 0)
9206 error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
9207
9208 num = get_number (&p);
9209 if (num == 0)
9210 error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args);
9211 if (*p == 0)
9212 error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
9213
9214 set_ignore_count (num,
9215 longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))),
9216 from_tty);
9217 if (from_tty)
9218 printf_filtered ("\n");
9219 }
9220 \f
9221 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints
9222 whose numbers are given in ARGS. */
9223
9224 static void
9225 map_breakpoint_numbers (char *args, void (*function) (struct breakpoint *))
9226 {
9227 char *p = args;
9228 char *p1;
9229 int num;
9230 struct breakpoint *b, *tmp;
9231 int match;
9232
9233 if (p == 0)
9234 error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
9235
9236 while (*p)
9237 {
9238 match = 0;
9239 p1 = p;
9240
9241 num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
9242 if (num == 0)
9243 {
9244 warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%s'"), p);
9245 }
9246 else
9247 {
9248 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, tmp)
9249 if (b->number == num)
9250 {
9251 struct breakpoint *related_breakpoint = b->related_breakpoint;
9252 match = 1;
9253 function (b);
9254 if (related_breakpoint)
9255 function (related_breakpoint);
9256 break;
9257 }
9258 if (match == 0)
9259 printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), num);
9260 }
9261 p = p1;
9262 }
9263 }
9264
9265 static struct bp_location *
9266 find_location_by_number (char *number)
9267 {
9268 char *dot = strchr (number, '.');
9269 char *p1;
9270 int bp_num;
9271 int loc_num;
9272 struct breakpoint *b;
9273 struct bp_location *loc;
9274
9275 *dot = '\0';
9276
9277 p1 = number;
9278 bp_num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
9279 if (bp_num == 0)
9280 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
9281
9282 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9283 if (b->number == bp_num)
9284 {
9285 break;
9286 }
9287
9288 if (!b || b->number != bp_num)
9289 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
9290
9291 p1 = dot+1;
9292 loc_num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
9293 if (loc_num == 0)
9294 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), number);
9295
9296 --loc_num;
9297 loc = b->loc;
9298 for (;loc_num && loc; --loc_num, loc = loc->next)
9299 ;
9300 if (!loc)
9301 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), dot+1);
9302
9303 return loc;
9304 }
9305
9306
9307 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
9308 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
9309 which ends with a period (no newline). */
9310
9311 void
9312 disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9313 {
9314 /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
9315 hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
9316 watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */
9317 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
9318 return;
9319
9320 /* You can't disable permanent breakpoints. */
9321 if (bpt->enable_state == bp_permanent)
9322 return;
9323
9324 bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled;
9325
9326 update_global_location_list (0);
9327
9328 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt->number);
9329 }
9330
9331 static void
9332 disable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9333 {
9334 struct breakpoint *bpt;
9335 if (args == 0)
9336 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
9337 switch (bpt->type)
9338 {
9339 case bp_none:
9340 warning (_("attempted to disable apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
9341 bpt->number);
9342 continue;
9343 case bp_breakpoint:
9344 case bp_tracepoint:
9345 case bp_catchpoint:
9346 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
9347 case bp_watchpoint:
9348 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9349 case bp_read_watchpoint:
9350 case bp_access_watchpoint:
9351 disable_breakpoint (bpt);
9352 default:
9353 continue;
9354 }
9355 else if (strchr (args, '.'))
9356 {
9357 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (args);
9358 if (loc)
9359 loc->enabled = 0;
9360 update_global_location_list (0);
9361 }
9362 else
9363 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, disable_breakpoint);
9364 }
9365
9366 static void
9367 do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition)
9368 {
9369 int target_resources_ok, other_type_used;
9370 struct value *mark;
9371
9372 if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
9373 {
9374 int i;
9375 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
9376 target_resources_ok =
9377 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
9378 i + 1, 0);
9379 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
9380 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
9381 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
9382 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
9383 }
9384
9385 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint
9386 || bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
9387 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
9388 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
9389 {
9390 struct gdb_exception e;
9391
9392 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
9393 {
9394 update_watchpoint (bpt, 1 /* reparse */);
9395 }
9396 if (e.reason < 0)
9397 {
9398 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
9399 bpt->number);
9400 return;
9401 }
9402 }
9403
9404 if (bpt->enable_state != bp_permanent)
9405 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
9406 bpt->disposition = disposition;
9407 update_global_location_list (1);
9408 breakpoints_changed ();
9409
9410 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt->number);
9411 }
9412
9413
9414 void
9415 enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9416 {
9417 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, bpt->disposition);
9418 }
9419
9420 /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints (or all defined
9421 breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to be) effective
9422 in stopping the inferior. */
9423
9424 static void
9425 enable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9426 {
9427 struct breakpoint *bpt;
9428 if (args == 0)
9429 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
9430 switch (bpt->type)
9431 {
9432 case bp_none:
9433 warning (_("attempted to enable apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
9434 bpt->number);
9435 continue;
9436 case bp_breakpoint:
9437 case bp_tracepoint:
9438 case bp_catchpoint:
9439 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
9440 case bp_watchpoint:
9441 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9442 case bp_read_watchpoint:
9443 case bp_access_watchpoint:
9444 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
9445 default:
9446 continue;
9447 }
9448 else if (strchr (args, '.'))
9449 {
9450 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (args);
9451 if (loc)
9452 loc->enabled = 1;
9453 update_global_location_list (1);
9454 }
9455 else
9456 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_breakpoint);
9457 }
9458
9459 static void
9460 enable_once_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9461 {
9462 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, disp_disable);
9463 }
9464
9465 static void
9466 enable_once_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9467 {
9468 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_once_breakpoint);
9469 }
9470
9471 static void
9472 enable_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9473 {
9474 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, disp_del);
9475 }
9476
9477 static void
9478 enable_delete_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9479 {
9480 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_delete_breakpoint);
9481 }
9482 \f
9483 static void
9484 set_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
9485 {
9486 }
9487
9488 static void
9489 show_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
9490 {
9491 }
9492
9493 /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
9494 the memory which that value represents has been written to by
9495 GDB itself. */
9496
9497 static void
9498 invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (CORE_ADDR addr, int len,
9499 const bfd_byte *data)
9500 {
9501 struct breakpoint *bp;
9502
9503 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
9504 if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled
9505 && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
9506 && bp->val_valid && bp->val)
9507 {
9508 struct bp_location *loc;
9509
9510 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
9511 if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
9512 && loc->address + loc->length > addr
9513 && addr + len > loc->address)
9514 {
9515 value_free (bp->val);
9516 bp->val = NULL;
9517 bp->val_valid = 0;
9518 }
9519 }
9520 }
9521
9522 /* Use default_breakpoint_'s, or nothing if they aren't valid. */
9523
9524 struct symtabs_and_lines
9525 decode_line_spec_1 (char *string, int funfirstline)
9526 {
9527 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
9528 if (string == 0)
9529 error (_("Empty line specification."));
9530 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
9531 sals = decode_line_1 (&string, funfirstline,
9532 default_breakpoint_symtab,
9533 default_breakpoint_line,
9534 (char ***) NULL, NULL);
9535 else
9536 sals = decode_line_1 (&string, funfirstline,
9537 (struct symtab *) NULL, 0, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
9538 if (*string)
9539 error (_("Junk at end of line specification: %s"), string);
9540 return sals;
9541 }
9542
9543 /* Create and insert a raw software breakpoint at PC. Return an
9544 identifier, which should be used to remove the breakpoint later.
9545 In general, places which call this should be using something on the
9546 breakpoint chain instead; this function should be eliminated
9547 someday. */
9548
9549 void *
9550 deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9551 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
9552 {
9553 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt;
9554
9555 bp_tgt = XZALLOC (struct bp_target_info);
9556
9557 bp_tgt->placed_address_space = aspace;
9558 bp_tgt->placed_address = pc;
9559
9560 if (target_insert_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_tgt) != 0)
9561 {
9562 /* Could not insert the breakpoint. */
9563 xfree (bp_tgt);
9564 return NULL;
9565 }
9566
9567 return bp_tgt;
9568 }
9569
9570 /* Remove a breakpoint BP inserted by deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint. */
9571
9572 int
9573 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, void *bp)
9574 {
9575 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = bp;
9576 int ret;
9577
9578 ret = target_remove_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_tgt);
9579 xfree (bp_tgt);
9580
9581 return ret;
9582 }
9583
9584 /* One (or perhaps two) breakpoints used for software single stepping. */
9585
9586 static void *single_step_breakpoints[2];
9587 static struct gdbarch *single_step_gdbarch[2];
9588
9589 /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */
9590
9591 void
9592 insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9593 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR next_pc)
9594 {
9595 void **bpt_p;
9596
9597 if (single_step_breakpoints[0] == NULL)
9598 {
9599 bpt_p = &single_step_breakpoints[0];
9600 single_step_gdbarch[0] = gdbarch;
9601 }
9602 else
9603 {
9604 gdb_assert (single_step_breakpoints[1] == NULL);
9605 bpt_p = &single_step_breakpoints[1];
9606 single_step_gdbarch[1] = gdbarch;
9607 }
9608
9609 /* NOTE drow/2006-04-11: A future improvement to this function would be
9610 to only create the breakpoints once, and actually put them on the
9611 breakpoint chain. That would let us use set_raw_breakpoint. We could
9612 adjust the addresses each time they were needed. Doing this requires
9613 corresponding changes elsewhere where single step breakpoints are
9614 handled, however. So, for now, we use this. */
9615
9616 *bpt_p = deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, aspace, next_pc);
9617 if (*bpt_p == NULL)
9618 error (_("Could not insert single-step breakpoint at %s"),
9619 paddress (gdbarch, next_pc));
9620 }
9621
9622 /* Remove and delete any breakpoints used for software single step. */
9623
9624 void
9625 remove_single_step_breakpoints (void)
9626 {
9627 gdb_assert (single_step_breakpoints[0] != NULL);
9628
9629 /* See insert_single_step_breakpoint for more about this deprecated
9630 call. */
9631 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[0],
9632 single_step_breakpoints[0]);
9633 single_step_gdbarch[0] = NULL;
9634 single_step_breakpoints[0] = NULL;
9635
9636 if (single_step_breakpoints[1] != NULL)
9637 {
9638 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[1],
9639 single_step_breakpoints[1]);
9640 single_step_gdbarch[1] = NULL;
9641 single_step_breakpoints[1] = NULL;
9642 }
9643 }
9644
9645 /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at PC. */
9646
9647 static int
9648 single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
9649 {
9650 int i;
9651
9652 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
9653 {
9654 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = single_step_breakpoints[i];
9655 if (bp_tgt
9656 && breakpoint_address_match (bp_tgt->placed_address_space,
9657 bp_tgt->placed_address,
9658 aspace, pc))
9659 return 1;
9660 }
9661
9662 return 0;
9663 }
9664
9665 /* Returns 0 if 'bp' is NOT a syscall catchpoint,
9666 non-zero otherwise. */
9667 static int
9668 is_syscall_catchpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *bp)
9669 {
9670 if (syscall_catchpoint_p (bp)
9671 && bp->enable_state != bp_disabled
9672 && bp->enable_state != bp_call_disabled)
9673 return 1;
9674 else
9675 return 0;
9676 }
9677
9678 int
9679 catch_syscall_enabled (void)
9680 {
9681 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
9682
9683 return inf->total_syscalls_count != 0;
9684 }
9685
9686 int
9687 catching_syscall_number (int syscall_number)
9688 {
9689 struct breakpoint *bp;
9690
9691 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
9692 if (is_syscall_catchpoint_enabled (bp))
9693 {
9694 if (bp->syscalls_to_be_caught)
9695 {
9696 int i, iter;
9697 for (i = 0;
9698 VEC_iterate (int, bp->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
9699 i++)
9700 if (syscall_number == iter)
9701 return 1;
9702 }
9703 else
9704 return 1;
9705 }
9706
9707 return 0;
9708 }
9709
9710 /* Complete syscall names. Used by "catch syscall". */
9711 static char **
9712 catch_syscall_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
9713 char *text, char *word)
9714 {
9715 const char **list = get_syscall_names ();
9716 return (list == NULL) ? NULL : complete_on_enum (list, text, word);
9717 }
9718
9719 /* Tracepoint-specific operations. */
9720
9721 /* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */
9722 static void
9723 set_tracepoint_count (int num)
9724 {
9725 tracepoint_count = num;
9726 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num);
9727 }
9728
9729 void
9730 trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9731 {
9732 break_command_really (get_current_arch (),
9733 arg,
9734 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
9735 0 /* tempflag */, 0 /* hardwareflag */,
9736 1 /* traceflag */,
9737 0 /* Ignore count */,
9738 pending_break_support,
9739 NULL,
9740 from_tty,
9741 1 /* enabled */);
9742 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
9743 }
9744
9745 /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
9746 omitted. */
9747
9748 static void
9749 tracepoints_info (char *tpnum_exp, int from_tty)
9750 {
9751 struct breakpoint *b;
9752 int tps_to_list = 0;
9753
9754 /* In the no-arguments case, say "No tracepoints" if none found. */
9755 if (tpnum_exp == 0)
9756 {
9757 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
9758 {
9759 if (b->number >= 0)
9760 {
9761 tps_to_list = 1;
9762 break;
9763 }
9764 }
9765 if (!tps_to_list)
9766 {
9767 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No tracepoints.\n");
9768 return;
9769 }
9770 }
9771
9772 /* Otherwise be the same as "info break". */
9773 breakpoints_info (tpnum_exp, from_tty);
9774 }
9775
9776 /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
9777 Not supported by all targets. */
9778 static void
9779 enable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9780 {
9781 enable_command (args, from_tty);
9782 }
9783
9784 /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
9785 Not supported by all targets. */
9786 static void
9787 disable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9788 {
9789 disable_command (args, from_tty);
9790 }
9791
9792 /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument) */
9793 static void
9794 delete_trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9795 {
9796 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
9797
9798 dont_repeat ();
9799
9800 if (arg == 0)
9801 {
9802 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
9803
9804 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
9805 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
9806 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number argument. */
9807 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
9808 {
9809 if (b->number >= 0)
9810 {
9811 breaks_to_delete = 1;
9812 break;
9813 }
9814 }
9815
9816 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
9817 if (!from_tty
9818 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
9819 {
9820 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
9821 {
9822 if (b->type == bp_tracepoint
9823 && b->number >= 0)
9824 delete_breakpoint (b);
9825 }
9826 }
9827 }
9828 else
9829 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, delete_breakpoint);
9830 }
9831
9832 /* Set passcount for tracepoint.
9833
9834 First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
9835 If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
9836 Also accepts special argument "all". */
9837
9838 static void
9839 trace_pass_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9840 {
9841 struct breakpoint *t1 = (struct breakpoint *) -1, *t2;
9842 unsigned int count;
9843 int all = 0;
9844
9845 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
9846 error (_("passcount command requires an argument (count + optional TP num)"));
9847
9848 count = strtoul (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
9849
9850 while (*args && isspace ((int) *args))
9851 args++;
9852
9853 if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0)
9854 {
9855 args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */
9856 all = 1;
9857 if (*args)
9858 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
9859 }
9860 else
9861 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, 1, 1);
9862
9863 do
9864 {
9865 if (t1)
9866 {
9867 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t2)
9868 if (t1 == (struct breakpoint *) -1 || t1 == t2)
9869 {
9870 t2->pass_count = count;
9871 observer_notify_tracepoint_modified (t2->number);
9872 if (from_tty)
9873 printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
9874 t2->number, count);
9875 }
9876 if (! all && *args)
9877 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, 1, 0);
9878 }
9879 }
9880 while (*args);
9881 }
9882
9883 struct breakpoint *
9884 get_tracepoint (int num)
9885 {
9886 struct breakpoint *t;
9887
9888 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
9889 if (t->number == num)
9890 return t;
9891
9892 return NULL;
9893 }
9894
9895 /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
9896 If MULTI_P is true, there might be a range of tracepoints in ARG.
9897 if OPTIONAL_P is true, then if the argument is missing, the most
9898 recent tracepoint (tracepoint_count) is returned. */
9899 struct breakpoint *
9900 get_tracepoint_by_number (char **arg, int multi_p, int optional_p)
9901 {
9902 extern int tracepoint_count;
9903 struct breakpoint *t;
9904 int tpnum;
9905 char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg;
9906
9907 if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg)
9908 {
9909 if (optional_p)
9910 tpnum = tracepoint_count;
9911 else
9912 error_no_arg (_("tracepoint number"));
9913 }
9914 else
9915 tpnum = multi_p ? get_number_or_range (arg) : get_number (arg);
9916
9917 if (tpnum <= 0)
9918 {
9919 if (instring && *instring)
9920 printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
9921 instring);
9922 else
9923 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint argument missing and no previous tracepoint\n"));
9924 return NULL;
9925 }
9926
9927 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
9928 if (t->number == tpnum)
9929 {
9930 return t;
9931 }
9932
9933 /* FIXME: if we are in the middle of a range we don't want to give
9934 a message. The current interface to get_number_or_range doesn't
9935 allow us to discover this. */
9936 printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
9937 return NULL;
9938 }
9939
9940 /* save-tracepoints command */
9941 static void
9942 tracepoint_save_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9943 {
9944 struct breakpoint *tp;
9945 int any_tp = 0;
9946 struct action_line *line;
9947 FILE *fp;
9948 char *i1 = " ", *i2 = " ";
9949 char *indent, *actionline, *pathname;
9950 char tmp[40];
9951 struct cleanup *cleanup;
9952
9953 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
9954 error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save tracepoints)"));
9955
9956 /* See if we have anything to save. */
9957 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
9958 {
9959 any_tp = 1;
9960 break;
9961 }
9962 if (!any_tp)
9963 {
9964 warning (_("save-tracepoints: no tracepoints to save."));
9965 return;
9966 }
9967
9968 pathname = tilde_expand (args);
9969 cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, pathname);
9970 fp = fopen (pathname, "w");
9971 if (!fp)
9972 error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving tracepoints (%s)"),
9973 args, safe_strerror (errno));
9974 make_cleanup_fclose (fp);
9975
9976 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
9977 {
9978 if (tp->addr_string)
9979 fprintf (fp, "trace %s\n", tp->addr_string);
9980 else
9981 {
9982 sprintf_vma (tmp, tp->loc->address);
9983 fprintf (fp, "trace *0x%s\n", tmp);
9984 }
9985
9986 if (tp->pass_count)
9987 fprintf (fp, " passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count);
9988
9989 if (tp->actions)
9990 {
9991 fprintf (fp, " actions\n");
9992 indent = i1;
9993 for (line = tp->actions; line; line = line->next)
9994 {
9995 struct cmd_list_element *cmd;
9996
9997 QUIT; /* allow user to bail out with ^C */
9998 actionline = line->action;
9999 while (isspace ((int) *actionline))
10000 actionline++;
10001
10002 fprintf (fp, "%s%s\n", indent, actionline);
10003 if (*actionline != '#') /* skip for comment lines */
10004 {
10005 cmd = lookup_cmd (&actionline, cmdlist, "", -1, 1);
10006 if (cmd == 0)
10007 error (_("Bad action list item: %s"), actionline);
10008 if (cmd_cfunc_eq (cmd, while_stepping_pseudocommand))
10009 indent = i2;
10010 else if (cmd_cfunc_eq (cmd, end_actions_pseudocommand))
10011 indent = i1;
10012 }
10013 }
10014 }
10015 }
10016 do_cleanups (cleanup);
10017 if (from_tty)
10018 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoints saved to file '%s'.\n"), args);
10019 return;
10020 }
10021
10022 /* Create a vector of all tracepoints. */
10023
10024 VEC(breakpoint_p) *
10025 all_tracepoints ()
10026 {
10027 VEC(breakpoint_p) *tp_vec = 0;
10028 struct breakpoint *tp;
10029
10030 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
10031 {
10032 VEC_safe_push (breakpoint_p, tp_vec, tp);
10033 }
10034
10035 return tp_vec;
10036 }
10037
10038 \f
10039 /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak commands.
10040 It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
10041 COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the command. */
10042 #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
10043 command" [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM] [if CONDITION]\n\
10044 LOCATION may be a line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
10045 If a line number is specified, break at start of code for that line.\n\
10046 If a function is specified, break at start of code for that function.\n\
10047 If an address is specified, break at that exact address.\n\
10048 With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of selected stack frame.\n\
10049 This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
10050 \n\
10051 THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
10052 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
10053 \n\
10054 Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if conditional.\n\
10055 \n\
10056 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
10057
10058 /* List of subcommands for "catch". */
10059 static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist;
10060
10061 /* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */
10062 static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist;
10063
10064 /* Like add_cmd, but add the command to both the "catch" and "tcatch"
10065 lists, and pass some additional user data to the command function. */
10066 static void
10067 add_catch_command (char *name, char *docstring,
10068 void (*sfunc) (char *args, int from_tty,
10069 struct cmd_list_element *command),
10070 char **(*completer) (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
10071 char *text, char *word),
10072 void *user_data_catch,
10073 void *user_data_tcatch)
10074 {
10075 struct cmd_list_element *command;
10076
10077 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
10078 &catch_cmdlist);
10079 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
10080 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_catch);
10081 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
10082
10083 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
10084 &tcatch_cmdlist);
10085 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
10086 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_tcatch);
10087 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
10088 }
10089
10090 static void
10091 clear_syscall_counts (int pid)
10092 {
10093 struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
10094
10095 inf->total_syscalls_count = 0;
10096 inf->any_syscall_count = 0;
10097 VEC_free (int, inf->syscalls_counts);
10098 }
10099
10100 void
10101 _initialize_breakpoint (void)
10102 {
10103 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist;
10104 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist;
10105 struct cmd_list_element *c;
10106
10107 observer_attach_solib_unloaded (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib);
10108 observer_attach_inferior_exit (clear_syscall_counts);
10109 observer_attach_memory_changed (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change);
10110
10111 breakpoint_chain = 0;
10112 /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful
10113 before a breakpoint is set. */
10114 breakpoint_count = 0;
10115
10116 tracepoint_count = 0;
10117
10118 add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\
10119 Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
10120 Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
10121 if (xdb_commands)
10122 add_com_alias ("bc", "ignore", class_breakpoint, 1);
10123
10124 add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint, commands_command, _("\
10125 Set commands to be executed when a breakpoint is hit.\n\
10126 Give breakpoint number as argument after \"commands\".\n\
10127 With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
10128 The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
10129 Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
10130 Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
10131 then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
10132
10133 add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, _("\
10134 Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
10135 Usage is `condition N COND', where N is an integer and COND is an\n\
10136 expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached."));
10137
10138 c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\
10139 Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
10140 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
10141 so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
10142 by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
10143 \n"
10144 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
10145 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10146
10147 c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\
10148 Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
10149 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
10150 some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
10151 \n"
10152 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
10153 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10154
10155 c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\
10156 Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
10157 Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
10158 so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
10159 \n"
10160 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
10161 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10162
10163 add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
10164 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
10165 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
10166 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
10167 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
10168 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
10169 &enablelist, "enable ", 1, &cmdlist);
10170 if (xdb_commands)
10171 add_com ("ab", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
10172 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
10173 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
10174 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
10175 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
10176 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."));
10177
10178 add_com_alias ("en", "enable", class_breakpoint, 1);
10179
10180 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
10181 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
10182 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
10183 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
10184 May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\".\n"),
10185 &enablebreaklist, "enable breakpoints ", 1, &enablelist);
10186
10187 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
10188 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10189 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
10190 &enablebreaklist);
10191
10192 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
10193 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10194 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
10195 &enablebreaklist);
10196
10197 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
10198 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10199 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
10200 &enablelist);
10201
10202 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
10203 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10204 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
10205 &enablelist);
10206
10207 add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
10208 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
10209 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10210 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10211 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled."),
10212 &disablelist, "disable ", 1, &cmdlist);
10213 add_com_alias ("dis", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
10214 add_com_alias ("disa", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
10215 if (xdb_commands)
10216 add_com ("sb", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
10217 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
10218 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10219 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10220 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled."));
10221
10222 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, disable_command, _("\
10223 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
10224 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10225 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10226 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled.\n\
10227 This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
10228 &disablelist);
10229
10230 add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
10231 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
10232 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10233 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10234 \n\
10235 Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects.\n\
10236 The \"unset\" command is also an alias for \"delete\"."),
10237 &deletelist, "delete ", 1, &cmdlist);
10238 add_com_alias ("d", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
10239 add_com_alias ("del", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
10240 if (xdb_commands)
10241 add_com ("db", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
10242 Delete some breakpoints.\n\
10243 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10244 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n"));
10245
10246 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, delete_command, _("\
10247 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
10248 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10249 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10250 This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
10251 &deletelist);
10252
10253 add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\
10254 Clear breakpoint at specified line or function.\n\
10255 Argument may be line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
10256 If line number is specified, all breakpoints in that line are cleared.\n\
10257 If function is specified, breakpoints at beginning of function are cleared.\n\
10258 If an address is specified, breakpoints at that address are cleared.\n\
10259 \n\
10260 With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
10261 is executing in.\n\
10262 \n\
10263 See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
10264
10265 c = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\
10266 Set breakpoint at specified line or function.\n"
10267 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
10268 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10269
10270 add_com_alias ("b", "break", class_run, 1);
10271 add_com_alias ("br", "break", class_run, 1);
10272 add_com_alias ("bre", "break", class_run, 1);
10273 add_com_alias ("brea", "break", class_run, 1);
10274
10275 if (xdb_commands)
10276 add_com_alias ("ba", "break", class_breakpoint, 1);
10277
10278 if (dbx_commands)
10279 {
10280 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint, stop_command, _("\
10281 Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."),
10282 &stoplist, "stop ", 1, &cmdlist);
10283 add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint, stopin_command,
10284 _("Break in function or address."), &stoplist);
10285 add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint, stopat_command,
10286 _("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist);
10287 add_com ("status", class_info, breakpoints_info, _("\
10288 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10289 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10290 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10291 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10292 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10293 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10294 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10295 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10296 \n\
10297 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10298 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10299 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10300 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10301 breakpoint set."));
10302 }
10303
10304 add_info ("breakpoints", breakpoints_info, _("\
10305 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10306 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10307 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10308 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10309 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10310 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10311 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10312 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10313 \n\
10314 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10315 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10316 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10317 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10318 breakpoint set."));
10319
10320 add_info_alias ("b", "breakpoints", 1);
10321
10322 if (xdb_commands)
10323 add_com ("lb", class_breakpoint, breakpoints_info, _("\
10324 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10325 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10326 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10327 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10328 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10329 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10330 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10331 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10332 \n\
10333 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10334 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10335 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10336 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10337 breakpoint set."));
10338
10339 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\
10340 Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10341 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10342 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10343 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10344 \tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
10345 \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
10346 \tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
10347 \tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
10348 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10349 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10350 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10351 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10352 \n\
10353 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10354 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10355 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10356 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10357 breakpoint set."),
10358 &maintenanceinfolist);
10359
10360 add_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, catch_command, _("\
10361 Set catchpoints to catch events."),
10362 &catch_cmdlist, "catch ",
10363 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
10364
10365 add_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, tcatch_command, _("\
10366 Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
10367 &tcatch_cmdlist, "tcatch ",
10368 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
10369
10370 /* Add catch and tcatch sub-commands. */
10371 add_catch_command ("catch", _("\
10372 Catch an exception, when caught.\n\
10373 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10374 catch_catch_command,
10375 NULL,
10376 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10377 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10378 add_catch_command ("throw", _("\
10379 Catch an exception, when thrown.\n\
10380 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10381 catch_throw_command,
10382 NULL,
10383 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10384 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10385 add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."),
10386 catch_fork_command_1,
10387 NULL,
10388 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent,
10389 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary);
10390 add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."),
10391 catch_fork_command_1,
10392 NULL,
10393 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent,
10394 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary);
10395 add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."),
10396 catch_exec_command_1,
10397 NULL,
10398 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10399 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10400 add_catch_command ("syscall", _("\
10401 Catch system calls by their names and/or numbers.\n\
10402 Arguments say which system calls to catch. If no arguments\n\
10403 are given, every system call will be caught.\n\
10404 Arguments, if given, should be one or more system call names\n\
10405 (if your system supports that), or system call numbers."),
10406 catch_syscall_command_1,
10407 catch_syscall_completer,
10408 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10409 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10410 add_catch_command ("exception", _("\
10411 Catch Ada exceptions, when raised.\n\
10412 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10413 catch_ada_exception_command,
10414 NULL,
10415 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10416 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10417 add_catch_command ("assert", _("\
10418 Catch failed Ada assertions, when raised.\n\
10419 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10420 catch_assert_command,
10421 NULL,
10422 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10423 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10424
10425 c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, _("\
10426 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
10427 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
10428 an expression changes."));
10429 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
10430
10431 c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, _("\
10432 Set a read watchpoint for an expression.\n\
10433 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
10434 an expression is read."));
10435 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
10436
10437 c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, _("\
10438 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
10439 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
10440 an expression is either read or written."));
10441 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
10442
10443 add_info ("watchpoints", breakpoints_info,
10444 _("Synonym for ``info breakpoints''."));
10445
10446
10447 /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
10448 respond to changes - contrary to the description. */
10449 add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support,
10450 &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\
10451 Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
10452 Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
10453 If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
10454 such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
10455 created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
10456 hardware.)"),
10457 NULL,
10458 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints,
10459 &setlist, &showlist);
10460
10461 can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1;
10462
10463 /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */
10464
10465 c = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\
10466 Set a tracepoint at specified line or function.\n\
10467 \n"
10468 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
10469 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
10470 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10471
10472 add_com_alias ("tp", "trace", class_alias, 0);
10473 add_com_alias ("tr", "trace", class_alias, 1);
10474 add_com_alias ("tra", "trace", class_alias, 1);
10475 add_com_alias ("trac", "trace", class_alias, 1);
10476
10477 add_info ("tracepoints", tracepoints_info, _("\
10478 Status of tracepoints, or tracepoint number NUMBER.\n\
10479 Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
10480 last tracepoint set."));
10481
10482 add_info_alias ("tp", "tracepoints", 1);
10483
10484 add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\
10485 Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
10486 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
10487 No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
10488 &deletelist);
10489
10490 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\
10491 Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
10492 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
10493 No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
10494 &disablelist);
10495 deprecate_cmd (c, "disable");
10496
10497 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\
10498 Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
10499 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
10500 No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
10501 &enablelist);
10502 deprecate_cmd (c, "enable");
10503
10504 add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\
10505 Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
10506 The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
10507 Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
10508 if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
10509
10510 c = add_com ("save-tracepoints", class_trace, tracepoint_save_command, _("\
10511 Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
10512 Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."));
10513 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
10514
10515 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, set_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
10516 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
10517 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
10518 pending breakpoint behavior"),
10519 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, "set breakpoint ",
10520 0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist);
10521 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, show_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
10522 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
10523 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
10524 pending breakpoint behavior"),
10525 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist, "show breakpoint ",
10526 0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist);
10527
10528 add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class,
10529 &pending_break_support, _("\
10530 Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
10531 Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
10532 If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
10533 pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
10534 an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
10535 user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
10536 NULL,
10537 show_pending_break_support,
10538 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
10539 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
10540
10541 pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
10542
10543 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class,
10544 &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\
10545 Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
10546 Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
10547 If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
10548 breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\
10549 a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
10550 NULL,
10551 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints,
10552 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
10553 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
10554
10555 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support,
10556 always_inserted_enums, &always_inserted_mode, _("\
10557 Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
10558 Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
10559 When this mode is off, breakpoints are inserted in inferior when it is\n\
10560 resumed, and removed when execution stops. When this mode is on,\n\
10561 breakpoints are inserted immediately and removed only when the user\n\
10562 deletes the breakpoint. When this mode is auto (which is the default),\n\
10563 the behaviour depends on the non-stop setting (see help set non-stop).\n\
10564 In this case, if gdb is controlling the inferior in non-stop mode, gdb\n\
10565 behaves as if always-inserted mode is on; if gdb is controlling the\n\
10566 inferior in all-stop mode, gdb behaves as if always-inserted mode is off."),
10567 NULL,
10568 &show_always_inserted_mode,
10569 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
10570 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
10571
10572 automatic_hardware_breakpoints = 1;
10573
10574 observer_attach_about_to_proceed (breakpoint_about_to_proceed);
10575 }
This page took 0.306975 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.